blob: bd9a99f13c99a300e300d0b0068737a081295967 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau7b677262017-04-03 09:27:49 +02007 2017/04/03
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000271 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000321Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004702.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100539 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100542 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200545 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100547 - presetenv
548 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200549 - uid
550 - ulimit-n
551 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100552 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200553 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200554 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-bind-options
556 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
557 - ssl-default-server-options
558 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100559 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100560 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100561 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100562 - 51degrees-data-file
563 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200564 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200565 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100566 - wurfl-data-file
567 - wurfl-information-list
568 - wurfl-information-list-separator
569 - wurfl-engine-mode
570 - wurfl-cache-size
571 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100572
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200574 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200576 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100577 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100578 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100579 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200580 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200581 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200582 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200583 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - noepoll
585 - nokqueue
586 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100587 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300588 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000589 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200590 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200591 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200592 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200593 - tune.buffers.limit
594 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200595 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200596 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100597 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100598 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200599 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100600 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100601 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100602 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100603 - tune.lua.session-timeout
604 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200605 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100606 - tune.maxaccept
607 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200608 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200609 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200610 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100611 - tune.rcvbuf.client
612 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100613 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100614 - tune.sndbuf.client
615 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100616 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100617 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200618 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100619 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200620 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200621 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100622 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200623 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100624 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200625 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
626 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
627 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100628 - tune.zlib.memlevel
629 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100630
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200631 * Debugging
632 - debug
633 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634
635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006363.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200637------------------------------------
638
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200639ca-base <dir>
640 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200641 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
642 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200643
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200644chroot <jail dir>
645 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
646 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
647 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
648 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
649 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
650 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100651
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100652cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
653 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
654 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
655 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100656 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
657 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
658 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
659 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
660 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
661 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
662 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
663 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
664 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
665 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100666
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200667crt-base <dir>
668 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
669 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
670 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672daemon
673 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
674 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
675 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
676
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200677deviceatlas-json-file <path>
678 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
679 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
680
681deviceatlas-log-level <value>
682 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
683 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
684
685deviceatlas-separator <char>
686 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
687 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
688
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100689deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200690 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
691 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
692 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100693
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900694external-check
695 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
696 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
697 See "option external-check".
698
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200699gid <number>
700 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
701 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
702 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100703 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
704 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200705 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100706
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100707hard-stop-after <time>
708 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
709
710 Arguments :
711 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
712 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
713 SIGUSR1 signal.
714
715 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
716 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
717 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
718
719 Example:
720 global
721 hard-stop-after 30s
722
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723group <group name>
724 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
725 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100726
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200727log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200728 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
729 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100730 configured with "log global".
731
732 <address> can be one of:
733
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100734 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100735 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
736 port).
737
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100738 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
739 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
740 port).
741
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100742 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
743 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
744 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
745 writeable).
746
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200747 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
748 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100749
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200750 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
751 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
752 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
753 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
754 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
755 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
756 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
757 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
758 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
759 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
760 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
761
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200762 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
763 one of the following :
764
765 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
766 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
767
768 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
769 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
770
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100771 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200772
773 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
774 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
775 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
776
777 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200778 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
779 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
780 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
781 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
782 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
783 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200784
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200785 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200786
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100787log-send-hostname [<string>]
788 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
789 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
790 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
791 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
792 the logs.
793
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000794log-tag <string>
795 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
796 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
797 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100798 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000799
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100800lua-load <file>
801 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
802 used multiple times.
803
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200804nbproc <number>
805 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
806 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
807 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
808 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
809 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
810
811pidfile <pidfile>
812 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
813 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
814 starting the process. See also "daemon".
815
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100816presetenv <name> <value>
817 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
818 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
819 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
820 and "unsetenv".
821
822resetenv [<name> ...]
823 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
824 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
825 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
826 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
827 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
828 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
829 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
830 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
831
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100832stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200833 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
834 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
835 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
836 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
837 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
838 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100839 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200840 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
841 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200842
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200843server-state-base <directory>
844 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200845 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
846 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200847
848server-state-file <file>
849 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
850 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
851 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
852 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
853 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
854 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
855 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
856 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200857 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
858 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200859
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100860setenv <name> <value>
861 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
862 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
863 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
864 and "unsetenv".
865
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100866ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
867 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
868 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300869 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100870 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
871 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
872 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
873 "bind" keyword for more information.
874
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100875ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
876 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
877 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
878 keyword to see available options.
879
880 Example:
881 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +0200882 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100883
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100884ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
885 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
886 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300887 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100888 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
889 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
890 information.
891
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100892ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
893 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
894 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
895 keyword to see available options.
896
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200897ssl-dh-param-file <file>
898 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
899 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
900 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
901 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
902 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200903 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
904 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
905 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
906 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200907 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
908 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
909 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
910
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100911ssl-server-verify [none|required]
912 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
913 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
914 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
915
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200916stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
917 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
918 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
919 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200920 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
921 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200922
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200923 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
924 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
925 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200926
927stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
928 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
929 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100930 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200931
932stats maxconn <connections>
933 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
934 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
935
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200936uid <number>
937 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
938 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
939 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
940 one. See also "gid" and "user".
941
942ulimit-n <number>
943 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
944 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
945 option.
946
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100947unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
948 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
949
950 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
951 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
952 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
953 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
954 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
955 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
956 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
957 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
958 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
959 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
960
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100961unsetenv [<name> ...]
962 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
963 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
964 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
965 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
966 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
967 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
968 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
969
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200970user <user name>
971 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
972 See also "uid" and "group".
973
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200974node <name>
975 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
976
977 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
978 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
979 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
980 traffic.
981
982description <text>
983 Add a text that describes the instance.
984
985 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
986 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
987 "<" and ">" characters.
988
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010098951degrees-data-file <file path>
990 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
991 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
992
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200993 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100994 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
995
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000099651degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100997 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
998 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
999 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1000
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001001 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001002 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1003
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200100451degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001005 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1006 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1007
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001008 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1009 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1010
101151degrees-cache-size <number>
1012 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1013 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1014 By default, this cache is disabled.
1015
1016 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001017 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1018
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001019wurfl-data-file <file path>
1020 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1021 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1022
1023 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1024 with USE_WURFL=1.
1025
1026wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1027 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1028 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1029 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1030
1031 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1032
1033 Valid WURFL properties are:
1034 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1035
1036 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1037 device.
1038
1039 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1040 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1041
1042 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1043 particular web request.
1044
1045 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1046 used Libwurfl API version.
1047
1048 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1049 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1050 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1051
1052 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1053 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1054
1055 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1056 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1057
1058 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1059
1060 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1061
1062 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1063 with USE_WURFL=1.
1064
1065wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1066 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1067 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1068
1069 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1070 with USE_WURFL=1.
1071
1072wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1073 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1074 thus before the chroot.
1075
1076 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1077 with USE_WURFL=1.
1078
1079wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1080 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1081 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1082 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1083 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1084 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1085 mode is enabled by default.
1086
1087 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1088 with USE_WURFL=1.
1089
1090wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1091 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1092 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1093 - "0" : no cache is used.
1094 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1095 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1096 the highest performing option.
1097
1098 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1099 with USE_WURFL=1.
1100
1101wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1102 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1103 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1104
1105 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1106 with USE_WURFL=1.
1107
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001108
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011093.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110-----------------------
1111
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001112max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1113 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1114 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1115 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1116 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1117 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1118 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1119 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1120 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1121
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001122maxconn <number>
1123 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1124 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1125 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001126 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1127 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1128 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1129 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001130 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1131 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1132 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1133 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1134 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001135
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001136maxconnrate <number>
1137 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1138 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1139 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1140 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1141 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1142 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1143 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1144 fairness.
1145
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001146maxcomprate <number>
1147 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001148 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001149 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1150 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1151 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1152 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1153 default value.
1154
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001155maxcompcpuusage <number>
1156 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1157 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1158 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1159 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1160 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1161 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1162 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1163 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1164
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001165maxpipes <number>
1166 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1167 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1168 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1169 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1170 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1171 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1172
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001173maxsessrate <number>
1174 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1175 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1176 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1177 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1178 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1179 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1180 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1181 fairness.
1182
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001183maxsslconn <number>
1184 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1185 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1186 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1187 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1188 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1189 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1190 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001191 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1192 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1193 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1194 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1195 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1196 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1197 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001198
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001199maxsslrate <number>
1200 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1201 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1202 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1203 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1204 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1205 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1206 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1207 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1208 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1209 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1210
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001211maxzlibmem <number>
1212 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1213 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1214 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001215 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1216 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1217 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1218
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001219noepoll
1220 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1221 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001222 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001223
1224nokqueue
1225 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1226 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1227 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1228
1229nopoll
1230 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1231 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001232 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001233 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001234
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001235nosplice
1236 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1237 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1238 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001239 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001240 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1241 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1242 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1243 "option splice-response".
1244
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001245nogetaddrinfo
1246 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1247 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1248
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001249noreuseport
1250 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1251 command line argument "-dR".
1252
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001253spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001254 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1255 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1256 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1257 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1258 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1259 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001260
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001261tune.buffers.limit <number>
1262 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1263 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1264 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1265 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1266 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1267 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1268 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1269 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1270 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1271 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1272 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1273 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1274 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1275 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1276 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1277
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001278tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1279 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1280 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1281 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1282 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1283
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001284tune.bufsize <number>
1285 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1286 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1287 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1288 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1289 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1290 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1291 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1292 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001293 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1294 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1295 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001296
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001297tune.chksize <number>
1298 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1299 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1300 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1301 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1302 checks whenever possible.
1303
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001304tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1305 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1306 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1307 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1308 this value. The default value is 1.
1309
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001310tune.http.cookielen <number>
1311 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1312 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1313 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1314 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1315 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1316 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1317 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1318 to change this value.
1319
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001320tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1321 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1322 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1323 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1324 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1325 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1326 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1327 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1328 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1329 limit too high.
1330
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001331tune.idletimer <timeout>
1332 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1333 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1334 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1335 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1336 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1337 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1338 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1339 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1340 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1341
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001342tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1343 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001344 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001345 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1346 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1347 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1348 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1349 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1350
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001351tune.lua.maxmem
1352 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1353 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1354 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1355 memory.
1356
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001357tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1358 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001359 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1360 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1361 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001362
1363tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1364 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1365 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1366 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1367 check servers.
1368
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001369tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1370 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1371 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1372 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1373 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1374
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001375tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001376 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1377 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1378 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1379 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1380 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1381 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1382 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1383 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1384 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1385 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001386
1387tune.maxpollevents <number>
1388 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1389 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1390 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1391 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1392 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1393
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001394tune.maxrewrite <number>
1395 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1396 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1397 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1398 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1399 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1400 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1401 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1402 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1403 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1404 bufsize.
1405
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001406tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1407 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1408 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1409 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1410 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1411 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1412 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1413 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1414 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1415 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1416 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1417 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1418 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1419 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1420 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1421 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1422 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1423 setting this parameter to 0.
1424
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001425tune.pipesize <number>
1426 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1427 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1428 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1429 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1430 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1431 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1432
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001433tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1434tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1435 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1436 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1437 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1438 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1439 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1440 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1441 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1442
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001443tune.recv_enough <number>
1444 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1445 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1446 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1447 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1448 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1449
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001450tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1451tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1452 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1453 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1454 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1455 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1456 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1457 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1458 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1459 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1460 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1461 notifying haproxy again.
1462
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001463tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001464 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1465 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1466 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001467 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001468 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1469 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1470 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1471 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1472 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001473 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1474 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001475
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001476tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1477 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1478 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1479 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1480 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1481 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1482 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1483
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001484tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1485 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001486 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001487 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1488 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1489 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1490 being used for too long.
1491
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001492tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1493 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1494 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1495 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1496 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1497 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1498 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1499 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1500 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1501 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1502 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001503 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1504 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001505
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001506tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1507 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1508 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1509 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1510 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1511 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1512 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1513 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001514 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1515 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001516
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001517tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1518 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1519 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1520 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1521 1000 entries.
1522
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001523tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1524 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1525 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1526 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1527
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001528tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001529tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001530tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1531tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1532tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001533 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1534 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1535 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1536 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1537 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1538 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1539 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1540 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001541
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001542 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1543 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1544 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1545 all available space is consumed.
1546 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1547 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1548 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001549
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001550tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1551 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001552 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001553 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1554 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1555 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1556
1557tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1558 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1559 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1560 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1561 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015633.3. Debugging
1564--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001565
1566debug
1567 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1568 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1569 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1570 system startup.
1571
1572quiet
1573 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1574 line argument "-q".
1575
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001576
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015773.4. Userlists
1578--------------
1579It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1580http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1581it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1582
1583userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001584 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001585 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1586
1587group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001588 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001589 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1590 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1591
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001592user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1593 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001594 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1595 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001596 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1597 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001598 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001599 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001600
1601
1602 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001603 userlist L1
1604 group G1 users tiger,scott
1605 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001606
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001607 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1608 user scott insecure-password elgato
1609 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001610
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001611 userlist L2
1612 group G1
1613 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001614
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001615 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1616 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1617 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001618
1619 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001620
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001621
16223.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001623----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001624It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1625several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1626instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1627values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1628automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1629In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1630using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1631tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1632reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1633Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1634that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1635each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001636
1637peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001638 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001639 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1640
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001641disabled
1642 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1643 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1644 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1645
1646enable
1647 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1648
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001649peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1650 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1651 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1652 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1653 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1654 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1655 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1656
1657 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1658 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1659
1660 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1661 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1662 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1663 across all peers.
1664
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001665 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1666 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001667
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001668 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001669 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001670 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1671 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1672 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001673
1674 backend mybackend
1675 mode tcp
1676 balance roundrobin
1677 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1678 stick on src
1679
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001680 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1681 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001682
1683
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090016843.6. Mailers
1685------------
1686It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1687If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1688in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1689
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001690mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001691 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1692 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1693
1694mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1695 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1696
1697 Example:
1698 mailers mymailers
1699 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1700 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1701
1702 backend mybackend
1703 mode tcp
1704 balance roundrobin
1705
1706 email-alert mailers mymailers
1707 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1708 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1709
1710 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1711 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1712
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001713timeout mail <time>
1714 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1715 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1716 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1717 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1718
1719 Example:
1720 mailers mymailers
1721 timeout mail 20s
1722 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017244. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001725----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001726
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001727Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001728 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001729 - frontend <name>
1730 - backend <name>
1731 - listen <name>
1732
1733A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1734its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1735section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001736section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001737
1738A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1739connections.
1740
1741A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1742to forward incoming connections.
1743
1744A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1745parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1746
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001747All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1748'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1749case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1750
1751Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1752logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1753proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1754However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1755name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1756
1757Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1758and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001759bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001760protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1761modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1762arbitrary criteria.
1763
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001764In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1765a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1766the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1767
1768 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1769 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1770 between responses and new requests.
1771
1772 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1773 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1774 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1775 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1776
1777 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1778 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1779 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1780
1781 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1782 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1783 client-facing connection remains open.
1784
1785 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1786 after the end of the response.
1787
1788The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1789frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1790following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1791weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1792
1793 Backend mode
1794
1795 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1796 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1797 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1798 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1799 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1800 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1801 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1802 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1803 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1804 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1805 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1806
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001807
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018094.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1810--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001811
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001812The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1813limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1814they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1815limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001816marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001817option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001818and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1819with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1820specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001821
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001822
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001823 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1824------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1825acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001826appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001827backlog X X X -
1828balance X - X X
1829bind - X X -
1830bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001831block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001832capture cookie - X X -
1833capture request header - X X -
1834capture response header - X X -
1835clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001836compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001837contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1838cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001839declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001840default-server X - X X
1841default_backend X X X -
1842description - X X X
1843disabled X X X X
1844dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001845email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001846email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001847email-alert mailers X X X X
1848email-alert myhostname X X X X
1849email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001850enabled X X X X
1851errorfile X X X X
1852errorloc X X X X
1853errorloc302 X X X X
1854-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1855errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001856force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001857filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001858fullconn X - X X
1859grace X X X X
1860hash-type X - X X
1861http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001862http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001863http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001864http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001865http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001866http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001867http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001868id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001869ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001870load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001871log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001872log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001873log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001874log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001875max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001876maxconn X X X -
1877mode X X X X
1878monitor fail - X X -
1879monitor-net X X X -
1880monitor-uri X X X -
1881option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1882option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1883option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1884option allbackups (*) X - X X
1885option checkcache (*) X - X X
1886option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1887option contstats (*) X X X -
1888option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1889option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1890option forceclose (*) X X X X
1891-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1892option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001893option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001894option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001895option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001896option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001897option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001898option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001899option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001900option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1901option httpchk X - X X
1902option httpclose (*) X X X X
1903option httplog X X X X
1904option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001905option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001906option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001907option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001908option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1909option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1910option logasap (*) X X X -
1911option mysql-check X - X X
1912option nolinger (*) X X X X
1913option originalto X X X X
1914option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001915option pgsql-check X - X X
1916option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001917option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001918option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001919option smtpchk X - X X
1920option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1921option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1922option splice-request (*) X X X X
1923option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01001924option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001925option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1926option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1927-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001928option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001929option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1930option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1931option tcpka X X X X
1932option tcplog X X X X
1933option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001934external-check command X - X X
1935external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001936persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1937rate-limit sessions X X X -
1938redirect - X X X
1939redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1940redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1941reqadd - X X X
1942reqallow - X X X
1943reqdel - X X X
1944reqdeny - X X X
1945reqiallow - X X X
1946reqidel - X X X
1947reqideny - X X X
1948reqipass - X X X
1949reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001950reqitarpit - X X X
1951reqpass - X X X
1952reqrep - X X X
1953-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001954reqtarpit - X X X
1955retries X - X X
1956rspadd - X X X
1957rspdel - X X X
1958rspdeny - X X X
1959rspidel - X X X
1960rspideny - X X X
1961rspirep - X X X
1962rsprep - X X X
1963server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001964server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02001965server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001966source X - X X
1967srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001968stats admin - X X X
1969stats auth X X X X
1970stats enable X X X X
1971stats hide-version X X X X
1972stats http-request - X X X
1973stats realm X X X X
1974stats refresh X X X X
1975stats scope X X X X
1976stats show-desc X X X X
1977stats show-legends X X X X
1978stats show-node X X X X
1979stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001980-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1981stick match - - X X
1982stick on - - X X
1983stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001984stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01001985stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001986tcp-check connect - - X X
1987tcp-check expect - - X X
1988tcp-check send - - X X
1989tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001990tcp-request connection - X X -
1991tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001992tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02001993tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001994tcp-response content - - X X
1995tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001996timeout check X - X X
1997timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001998timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001999timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2000timeout connect X - X X
2001timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2002timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2003timeout http-request X X X X
2004timeout queue X - X X
2005timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002006timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002007timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2008timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002009timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002010transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002011unique-id-format X X X -
2012unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002013use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002014use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002015------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2016 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002017
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002018
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020194.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2020---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002021
2022This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2023
2024
2025acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2026 Declare or complete an access list.
2027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2028 no | yes | yes | yes
2029 Example:
2030 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2031 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2032 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002034 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002035
2036
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002037appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2038 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002039 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2041 no | no | yes | yes
2042 Arguments :
2043 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2044 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2045
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002046 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002047 checked in each cookie value.
2048
2049 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2050 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2051 milliseconds.
2052
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002053 request-learn
2054 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2055 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2056 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2057 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2058 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2059 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2060
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002061 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2062 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2063 data following this prefix.
2064
2065 Example :
2066 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2067
2068 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2069 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2070
2071 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2072 2 modes are currently supported :
2073 - path-parameters :
2074 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2075 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2076 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2077 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2078 - query-string :
2079 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2080 query string.
2081
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002082 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2083 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2084 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002085
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002086 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2087 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002088
2089
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002090backlog <conns>
2091 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2093 yes | yes | yes | no
2094 Arguments :
2095 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2096 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002097 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002098
2099 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2100 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2101 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2102 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2103 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2104 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2105 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2106 backlog parameter.
2107
2108 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2109 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2110 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2111
2112 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2113
2114
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002115balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002116balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002117 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2119 yes | no | yes | yes
2120 Arguments :
2121 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2122 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2123 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2124 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2125
2126 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2127 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2128 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2129 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002130 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002131 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002132 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2133 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2134 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2135 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2136 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2137 it, so that you don't worry.
2138
2139 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2140 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2141 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2142 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2143 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2144 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2145 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2146 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002147
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002148 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2149 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2150 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2151 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2152 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2153 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2154 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2155 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2156
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002157 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002158 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002159 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2160 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002161 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002162 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2163 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2164 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2165 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2166 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002167 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2168 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2169 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2170 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2171 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2172 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002173
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002174 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2175 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2176 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2177 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2178 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2179 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2180 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2181 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002182 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002183 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002184 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2185 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2186 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002187
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002188 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2189 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2190 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2191 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2192 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2193 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2194 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2195 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2196 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2197 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2198 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2199 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002200
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002201 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002202 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2203 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2204 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2205 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2206 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2207 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2208 URIs start with a leading "/".
2209
2210 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2211 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2212 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2213 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2214
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002215 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002216 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2217
2218 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002219 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2220 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002221 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2222 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2223 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2224 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002225 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002226 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2227 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002228
2229 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2230 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2231 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2232 server will receive the request.
2233
2234 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2235 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2236 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2237 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2238 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002239 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2240 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2241 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002242
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002243 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2244 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2245 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2246 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2247 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002248
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002249 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002250 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2251 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2252 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2253
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002254 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2255 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2256 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2257
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002258 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002259 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002260 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2261 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2262 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2263 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2264 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2265 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002266 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002267 used instead.
2268
2269 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2270 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2271 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2272 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2273
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002274 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2275 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2276 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2277
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002278 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002279
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002280 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002281 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2282 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002283
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002284 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2285 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2286 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002287
2288 Examples :
2289 balance roundrobin
2290 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002291 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002292 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2293 balance hdr(host)
2294 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002295
2296 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2297 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002299 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002300 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2301 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2302 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2303 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2304
2305 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2306 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2307 defaults to 16 kB.
2308
2309 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2310 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2311
2312 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2313 Round Robin.
2314
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002315 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002316 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2317 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2318 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2319
2320 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2321
2322 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002323 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002324 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2325 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2326 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002327
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002328 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002329
2330
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002331bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2332bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002333 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2335 no | yes | yes | no
2336 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002337 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2338 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2339 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2340 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002341 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002342 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2343 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2344 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2345 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2346 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2347 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2348 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002349 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2350 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2351 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2352 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2353 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2354 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2355 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002356 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2357 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2358 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002359 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2360 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2361 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002362
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002363 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2364 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002365 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2366 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2367 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002368 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2369 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2370 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2371 the range.
2372
2373 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2374 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2375 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2376 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2377 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2378 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2379 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002380 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002381 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002382
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002383 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2384 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2385 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2386 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2387 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2388 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2389 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2390 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2391
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002392 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2393 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2394 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2395 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002396
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002397 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2398 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2399 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2400 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2401 in a frontend.
2402
2403 Example :
2404 listen http_proxy
2405 bind :80,:443
2406 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002407 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002408
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002409 listen http_https_proxy
2410 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002411 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002412
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002413 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2414 bind ipv6@:80
2415 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2416 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2417
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002418 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002419 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002420
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002421 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2422 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2423 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2424 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2425 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2426
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002427 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002428 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002429
2430
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002431bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002432 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2434 yes | yes | yes | yes
2435 Arguments :
2436 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2437 may be used to override a default value.
2438
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002439 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002440 option may be combined with other numbers.
2441
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002442 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002443 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2444 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2445 missing from all processes.
2446
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002447 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002448 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002449 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2450 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2451 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2452 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002453
2454 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2455 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2456 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2457 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2458 and 'even' instances.
2459
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002460 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2461 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2462 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2463 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002464
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002465 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2466 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2467
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002468 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2469 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2470 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2471
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002472 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2473 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2474
2475 Example :
2476 listen app_ip1
2477 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002478 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002479
2480 listen app_ip2
2481 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002482 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002483
2484 listen management
2485 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002486 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002487
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002488 listen management
2489 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2490 bind-process 1-4
2491
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002492 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002493
2494
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002495block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002496 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2498 no | yes | yes | yes
2499
2500 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2501 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002502 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002503 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002504 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002505 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2506 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2507 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002508
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002509 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2510 "http-request deny" instead.
2511
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002512 Example:
2513 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2514 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2515 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002516 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2517 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2518 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002519
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002520 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2521 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2522 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002523
2524capture cookie <name> len <length>
2525 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2527 no | yes | yes | no
2528 Arguments :
2529 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2530 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2531 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2532 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2533 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2534
2535 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2536 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2537 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2538 right if it exceeds <length>.
2539
2540 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2541 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2542 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2543 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2544
2545 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2546 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2547 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2548
2549 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2550 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2551 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002552 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2553 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2554 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002555
2556 Example:
2557 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2558
2559 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002560 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002561
2562
2563capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002564 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2566 no | yes | yes | no
2567 Arguments :
2568 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002569 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002570 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2571 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2572 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2573
2574 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2575 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2576 it exceeds <length>.
2577
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002578 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002579 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2580 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002581 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2582 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2583 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2584 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002585 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002586 environments to find where the request came from.
2587
2588 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2589 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2590 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2591 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002592
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002593 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2594 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2595 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2596 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2597 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002598
2599 Example:
2600 capture request header Host len 15
2601 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002602 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002603
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002604 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002605 about logging.
2606
2607
2608capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002609 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002610 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2611 no | yes | yes | no
2612 Arguments :
2613 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002614 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002615 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2616 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2617 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2618
2619 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2620 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2621 it exceeds <length>.
2622
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002623 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002624 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2625 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2626 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002627 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2628 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2629 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2630 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002631
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002632 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2633 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2634 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2635 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2636 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637
2638 Example:
2639 capture response header Content-length len 9
2640 capture response header Location len 15
2641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002642 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002643 about logging.
2644
2645
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002646clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002647 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2649 yes | yes | yes | no
2650 Arguments :
2651 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2652 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2653 as explained at the top of this document.
2654
2655 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2656 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2657 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2658 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2659 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2660 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2661 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2662 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002663 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002664 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2665 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2666
2667 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2668 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2669 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2670 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2671 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2672 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2673
2674 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2675 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2676
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002677 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2678 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002679
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002680compression algo <algorithm> ...
2681compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002682compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002683 Enable HTTP compression.
2684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2685 yes | yes | yes | yes
2686 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002687 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2688 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2689 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2690
2691 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002692 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2693 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2694 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002695
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002696 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002697 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002698
2699 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2700 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2701 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2702 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2703 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002704 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002705
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002706 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2707 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2708 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2709 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2710 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2711 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2712 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002713 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002714
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002715 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002716 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002717 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2718 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2719 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2720 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2721 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002722
2723 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2724 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2725 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2726 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2727 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002728 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2729 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2730 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2731 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2732 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002733 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2734 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002735
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002736 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002737 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2738 "Accept-Encoding" header
2739 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002740 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002741 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2742 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002743 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2744 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2745 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2746 "multipart"
2747 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2748 header
2749 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2750 and later
2751 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2752 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002753
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002754 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2755 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002756
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002757 Examples :
2758 compression algo gzip
2759 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002760
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002761
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002762contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002763 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2765 yes | no | yes | yes
2766 Arguments :
2767 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2768 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2769 as explained at the top of this document.
2770
2771 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002772 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002773 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002774 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2775 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2776 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2777 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2778
2779 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2780 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2781 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2782 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2783 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2784 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2785
2786 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2787 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2788 instead.
2789
2790 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2791 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2792
2793
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002794cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002795 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2796 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002797 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002798 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2800 yes | no | yes | yes
2801 Arguments :
2802 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2803 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2804 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2805 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2806 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2807 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2808 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2809 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2810 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2811
2812 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2813 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2814 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2815 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2816 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2817 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002818 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2819 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2820 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2821 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2822 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002823
2824 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002825 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002826
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002827 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002828 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2829 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2830 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2831 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2832 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2833 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2834 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2835 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2836 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2837 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002838
2839 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2840 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2841 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2842 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2843 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2844 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2845 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2846 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2847 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002848 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002849 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2850 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2851 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002852
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002853 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2854 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2855 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002856 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2857 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2858 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2859 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002860 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2861 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2862 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002863
2864 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2865 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2866 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2867 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2868 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2869 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2870 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2871 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2872 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2873
2874 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2875 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2876 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2877 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2878 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2879 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2880 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2881 persistence cookie in the cache.
2882 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2883
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002884 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2885 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2886 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2887 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2888 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2889 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2890 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2891 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2892 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2893 they logout.
2894
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002895 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2896 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2897 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2898 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2899
2900 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2901 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2902 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2903 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2904 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2905 this attribute.
2906
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002907 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002908 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002909 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2910 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2911 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2912 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2913 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2914 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002915
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002916 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2917 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2918 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2919 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2920 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2921 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2922 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2923 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2924 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2925 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2926 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2927 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2928 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2929 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2930 the site.
2931
2932 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2933 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2934 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2935 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2936 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2937 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2938 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2939 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2940 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2941 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2942 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2943 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2944 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2945 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2946 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2947 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2948
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002949 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
2950 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
2951 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
2952 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
2953 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
2954 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
2955
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002956 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2957 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2958 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2959 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002960
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002961 Examples :
2962 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2963 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2964 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002965 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002966
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002967 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002968
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002969
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002970declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2971 Declares a capture slot.
2972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2973 no | yes | yes | no
2974 Arguments:
2975 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2976
2977 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2978 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2979 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2980 for use in the response.
2981
2982 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002983 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002984 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2985
2986
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002987default-server [param*]
2988 Change default options for a server in a backend
2989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2990 yes | no | yes | yes
2991 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002992 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2993 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2994 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2995 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002996
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002997 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002998 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2999
3000 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003001
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003002
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003003default_backend <backend>
3004 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3006 yes | yes | yes | no
3007 Arguments :
3008 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3009
3010 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3011 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3012 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3013 will catch all undetermined requests.
3014
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003015 Example :
3016
3017 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3018 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3019 default_backend dynamic
3020
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003021 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003022
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003023
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003024description <string>
3025 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3027 no | yes | yes | yes
3028 Arguments : string
3029
3030 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3031 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3032 it describes.
3033 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3034
3035
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003036disabled
3037 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3039 yes | yes | yes | yes
3040 Arguments : none
3041
3042 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3043 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3044 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3045 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3046 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3047 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3048 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3049
3050 See also : "enabled"
3051
3052
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003053dispatch <address>:<port>
3054 Set a default server address
3055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3056 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003057 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003058
3059 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3060 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3061 during start-up.
3062
3063 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3064 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3065 possible with normal servers.
3066
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003067 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003068 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3069 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3070 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3071 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3072
3073 See also : "server"
3074
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003075
3076dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3077 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3079 yes | no | yes | yes
3080 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3081
3082 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
3083 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitely
3084 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3085 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
3086 That way, we can ensure session persistence accross multiple load-balancers,
3087 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003088
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003089enabled
3090 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3092 yes | yes | yes | yes
3093 Arguments : none
3094
3095 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3096 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3097
3098 See also : "disabled"
3099
3100
3101errorfile <code> <file>
3102 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3104 yes | yes | yes | yes
3105 Arguments :
3106 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04003107 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3108 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003109
3110 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003111 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003112 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003113 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3114 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003115
3116 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3117 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3118 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3119
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003120 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3121
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003122 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3123 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3124 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3125 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3126
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003127 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3128 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3129 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3130 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3131 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3132 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3133
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003134 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3135 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3136 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003137 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3139
3140 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3141
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003142 Example :
3143 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003144 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003145 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3146 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3147
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003148
3149errorloc <code> <url>
3150errorloc302 <code> <url>
3151 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3153 yes | yes | yes | yes
3154 Arguments :
3155 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Jarno Huuskonen013a84f2017-04-22 11:26:50 +03003156 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3157 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003158
3159 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3160 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3161 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3162 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3163 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3164
3165 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3166 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3167 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3168
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003169 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3170
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003171 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3172 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3173 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3174 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003175 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003176 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3177 request.
3178
3179 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3180
3181
3182errorloc303 <code> <url>
3183 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3185 yes | yes | yes | yes
3186 Arguments :
3187 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Jarno Huuskonen013a84f2017-04-22 11:26:50 +03003188 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3189 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003190
3191 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3192 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3193 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3194 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3195 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3196
3197 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3198 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3199 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3200
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003201 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3202
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003203 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3204 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3205 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3206 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003207 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003208
3209 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3210
3211
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003212email-alert from <emailaddr>
3213 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3214 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3215 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3216 yes | yes | yes | yes
3217
3218 Arguments :
3219
3220 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3221
3222 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3223 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3224
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003225 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003226 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3227 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003228
3229
3230email-alert level <level>
3231 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3232 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3233 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3234 yes | yes | yes | yes
3235
3236 Arguments :
3237
3238 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3239 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3240 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3241
3242 By default level is alert
3243
3244 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3245 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3246 for the proxy.
3247
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003248 Alerts are sent when :
3249
3250 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3251 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3252 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3253 is notice or lower
3254 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3255 and a health check status update occurs
3256
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003257 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3258 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003259 section 3.6 about mailers.
3260
3261
3262email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3263 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3264 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3265 yes | yes | yes | yes
3266
3267 Arguments :
3268
3269 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3270
3271 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3272 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3273
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003274 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3275 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003276
3277
3278email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3279 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3280 mailers.
3281 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3282 yes | yes | yes | yes
3283
3284 Arguments :
3285
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003286 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003287
3288 By default the systems hostname is used.
3289
3290 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3291 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3292 for the proxy.
3293
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003294 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3295 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003296
3297
3298email-alert to <emailaddr>
3299 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3300 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3301 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3302 yes | yes | yes | yes
3303
3304 Arguments :
3305
3306 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3307
3308 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3309 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3310
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003311 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003312 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3313
3314
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003315force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3316 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3317 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3318 no | yes | yes | yes
3319
3320 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3321 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3322 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3323 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3324 marked down for maintenance operations.
3325
3326 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3327 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3328 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3329 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3330 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3331 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3332 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3333 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3334 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3335
3336 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3337 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3338 is used.
3339
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003340 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003341 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003342
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003343
3344filter <name> [param*]
3345 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3347 no | yes | yes | yes
3348 Arguments :
3349 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3350 referenced in section 9.
3351
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003352 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003353 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003354 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3355 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003356
3357 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3358 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3359
3360 Example:
3361 listen
3362 bind *:80
3363
3364 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3365 filter compression
3366 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3367
3368 compression algo gzip
3369 compression offload
3370
3371 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3372
3373 See also : section 9.
3374
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003375
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003376fullconn <conns>
3377 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3379 yes | no | yes | yes
3380 Arguments :
3381 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3382 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3383
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003384 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003385 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003386 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003387 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3388 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3389 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3390 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3391 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003392 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003393
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003394 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3395 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003396 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3397 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3398 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003399
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003400 Example :
3401 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3402 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3403 # connections.
3404 backend dynamic
3405 fullconn 10000
3406 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3407 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3408
3409 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3410
3411
3412grace <time>
3413 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003415 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003416 Arguments :
3417 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3418 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3419 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3420
3421 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3422 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003423 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003424 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3425
3426 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3427 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3428 simplify it.
3429
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003430
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003431hash-balance-factor <factor>
3432 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3434 yes | no | no | yes
3435 Arguments :
3436 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3437 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3438 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3439
3440 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3441 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3442 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3443 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3444 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3445 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3446 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3447
3448 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3449 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3450 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3451 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3452 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3453
3454 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3455
3456
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003457hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003458 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3460 yes | no | yes | yes
3461 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003462 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3463 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003464
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003465 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3466 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3467 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3468 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3469 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3470 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3471 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3472 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3473 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3474 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003475
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003476 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3477 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3478 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3479 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3480 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3481 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3482 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3483 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3484 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3485 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3486 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3487 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3488 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003489 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3490 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003491
3492 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3493
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003494 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003495 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3496 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3497 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003498 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3499 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3500 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003501
3502 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3503 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003504 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3505 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3506 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3507 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3508
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003509 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3510 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3511 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3512 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3513 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3514 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3515 parameter.
3516
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003517 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3518 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3519 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3520 used on strings.
3521
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003522 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3523
3524 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3525 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3526 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3527 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3528 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3529 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3530 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3531 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3532 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3533 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3534 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3535 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003536
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003537 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3538 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3539 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003540
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003541 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003542
3543
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003544http-check disable-on-404
3545 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003547 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003548 Arguments : none
3549
3550 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3551 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3552 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3553 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3554 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3555 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3556 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3557 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003558 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3559 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3560 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3561
3562 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3563
3564
3565http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003566 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003568 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003569 Arguments :
3570 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3571 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003572 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003573 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3574 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3575 details on the supported keywords.
3576
3577 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3578 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3579 with the usual backslash ('\').
3580
3581 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3582 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3583 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3584 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3585 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3586
3587 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003588 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003589 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3590 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3591 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3592
3593 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003594 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003595 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3596 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3597 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3598 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3599
3600 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003601 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003602 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3603 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3604 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3605 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3606 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3607 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3608 trace).
3609
3610 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003611 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003612 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3613 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3614 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3615 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3616 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3617 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3618
3619 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3620 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3621 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3622 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3623 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3624 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3625 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3626 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3627
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003628 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3629 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3630 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3631
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003632 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3633 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3634
3635 Examples :
3636 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003637 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003638
3639 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003640 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003641
3642 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003643 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003644
3645 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003646 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003647
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003648 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003649
3650
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003651http-check send-state
3652 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3654 yes | no | yes | yes
3655 Arguments : none
3656
3657 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3658 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3659 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3660 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3661 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3662
3663 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3664 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3665 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3666 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3667 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003668 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3669 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3670 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3671
3672 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3673 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3674 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3675
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003676 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3677 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3678 checked in multiple backends.
3679
3680 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3681 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3682
3683 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3684 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3685 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3686 one fails.
3687
3688 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3689 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3690 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3691
3692 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3693 server's queue.
3694
3695 Example of a header received by the application server :
3696 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3697 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3698
3699 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3700
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003701http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3702 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003703 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003704 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003705 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003706 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3707 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003708 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3709 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003710 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3711 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3712 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003713 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003714 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003715 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003716 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003717 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003718 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003719 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003720 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003721 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003722 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3723
3724 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3725 no | yes | yes | yes
3726
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003727 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3728 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3729 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3730 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3731 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003732
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003733 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3734 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3735 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3736
3737 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003738 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3739 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3740 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3741 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003742
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003743 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3744 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3745 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003746 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3747 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003748 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3749 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3750 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3751 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3752 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003753 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003754 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3755 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003756
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003757 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3758 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3759 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3760 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3761 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3762
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003763 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3764 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3765 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003766 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3767 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003768
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003769 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3770 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3771 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3772 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3773 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3774 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3775 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3776 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3777
3778 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3779 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3780 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003781 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3782 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003783
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003784 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3785 <name>.
3786
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003787 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3788 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3789 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3790 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3791 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3792 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3793 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3794 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3795
3796 Example:
3797
3798 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3799
3800 applied to:
3801
3802 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3803
3804 outputs:
3805
3806 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3807
3808 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3809
3810 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3811 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3812 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3813 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3814 header.
3815
3816 Example:
3817
3818 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3819
3820 applied to:
3821
3822 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3823
3824 outputs:
3825
3826 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3827
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003828 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3829 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3830 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3831 it.
3832
3833 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3834 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3835 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3836 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3837 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3838 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3839
3840 Example :
3841 # prepend the host name before the path
3842 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3843
3844 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3845 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3846 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3847 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3848 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3849 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3850 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3851 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3852
3853 Example :
3854 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3855 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3856
3857 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3858 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3859 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3860 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3861 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3862 "set-query".
3863
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003864 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3865 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3866 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3867 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3868 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3869 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3870 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3871 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3872
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003873 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3874 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3875 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3876 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3877 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3878 another equipment.
3879
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003880 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3881 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3882 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3883 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3884 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3885 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3886 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3887 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3888
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003889 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3890 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3891 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3892 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3893 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3894 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3895 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3896 admin privileges.
3897
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003898 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3899 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3900 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3901 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3902 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3903 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3904 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3905 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3906
3907 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3908 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3909 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3910 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3911 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3912 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3913
3914 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3915 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3916 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3917 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3918 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3919 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3920
3921 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3922 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3923 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3924 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3925 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3926 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3927 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3928 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3929 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3930
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003931 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003932 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3933 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3934 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3935 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3936 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3937 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3938 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3939 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3940 request header" for more information.
3941
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003942 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3943 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3944 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3945 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003946 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3947 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003948
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003949 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3950 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3951 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3952 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3953 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3954 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3955 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3956 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3957 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3958 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3959 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3960 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3961
3962 These actions take one or two arguments :
3963 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3964 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3965 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3966 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3967
3968 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3969 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3970 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3971 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3972
3973 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3974 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3975 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3976 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3977 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3978 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3979 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3980 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3981
3982 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3983 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3984 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3985 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3986 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3987
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003988 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3989 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3990 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3991 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3992 continues.
3993
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003994 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3995 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3996 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3997 the actions evaluation continues.
3998
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003999 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4000 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4001 inline.
4002
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004003 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4004 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004005 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004006 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4007 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004008 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004009 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004010 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004011 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4012 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004013 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004014 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004015 and '_'.
4016
4017 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4018 followed by some converters.
4019
4020 Example:
4021
4022 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4023
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004024 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4025 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4026
4027 Example:
4028
4029 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4030
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004031 - set-src <expr> :
4032 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4033 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4034 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4035 source IP for privacy.
4036
4037 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4038 followed by some converters.
4039
4040 Example:
4041
4042 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4043 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4044
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004045 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4046 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004047
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004048 - set-src-port <expr> :
4049 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4050 expression.
4051
4052 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4053 followed by some converters.
4054
4055 Example:
4056
4057 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4058 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4059
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004060 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4061 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4062 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004063
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004064 - set-dst <expr> :
4065 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4066 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4067 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4068 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4069 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4070
4071 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4072 followed by some converters.
4073
4074 Example:
4075
4076 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4077 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4078
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004079 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4080 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4081
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004082 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4083 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4084 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4085 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4086
4087 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4088 followed by some converters.
4089
4090 Example:
4091
4092 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4093 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4094
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004095 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4096 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4097 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4098
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004099 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4100 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4101 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4102 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4103 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4104 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4105 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4106 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4107 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4108 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4109 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4110 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4111 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4112 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4113 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4114 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4115
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004116 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4117
4118 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4119 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004120 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4121 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4122
4123 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4124 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4125 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4126 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004127
4128 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004129 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4130 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4131 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004132
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004133 http-request allow if nagios
4134 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4135 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4136 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004137
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004138 Example:
4139 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004140 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004141
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004142 Example:
4143 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4144 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004145 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004146 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4147 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4148 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4149 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4150 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4151 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4152
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004153 Example:
4154 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4155 acl add path /addacl
4156 acl del path /delacl
4157
4158 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4159
4160 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4161 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4162
4163 Example:
4164 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4165 acl setmap path /setmap
4166 acl delmap path /delmap
4167
4168 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4169
4170 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4171 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4172
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004173 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4174 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004175
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004176http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004177 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004178 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004179 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4180 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004181 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004182 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4183 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4184 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4185 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004186 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004187 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004188 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004189 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004190 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004191 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004192 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004193 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004194 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004195 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4196
4197 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4198 no | yes | yes | yes
4199
4200 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4201 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4202 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4203 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4204 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4205 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4206
4207 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4208 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4209 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4210 current section.
4211
4212 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4213 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4214 rules are evaluated.
4215
4216 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4217 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4218 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4219 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4220 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4221 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4222 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4223
4224 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4225 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4226 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4227 external users.
4228
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004229 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4230 <name>.
4231
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004232 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4233 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4234 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4235 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4236 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4237 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4238 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4239 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4240
4241 Example:
4242
4243 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4244
4245 applied to:
4246
4247 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4248
4249 outputs:
4250
4251 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4252
4253 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4254
4255 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4256 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4257 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4258 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4259 header.
4260
4261 Example:
4262
4263 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4264
4265 applied to:
4266
4267 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4268
4269 outputs:
4270
4271 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4272
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004273 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004274 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4275 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4276 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004277
4278 Example:
4279
4280 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4281 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004282 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4283 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004284
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004285 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4286 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4287 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4288 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4289 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4290 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4291 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4292 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4293
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004294 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4295 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4296 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4297 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4298 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4299 another equipment.
4300
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004301 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4302 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4303 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4304 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4305 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4306 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4307 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4308 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4309
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004310 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4311 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4312 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4313 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4314 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4315 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4316 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4317 admin privileges.
4318
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004319 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4320 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4321 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4322 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4323 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4324 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4325 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4326 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4327
4328 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4329 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4330 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4331 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4332 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4333 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4334
4335 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4336 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4337 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4338 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4339 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4340 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4341
4342 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4343 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4344 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4345 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4346 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4347 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4348 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4349 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4350 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4351
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004352 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4353 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4354 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4355 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4356 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4357 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4358 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4359 response header" for more information.
4360
4361 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4362 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4363 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4364 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4365 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004366 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4367 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004368
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004369 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4370 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4371 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4372 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4373 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4374 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4375
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004376 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4377 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4378 inline.
4379
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004380 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4381 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004382 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004383 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4384 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004385 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004386 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004387 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004388 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4389 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004390 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004391 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4392 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004393
4394 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4395 followed by some converters.
4396
4397 Example:
4398
4399 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4400
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004401 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4402 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4403
4404 Example:
4405
4406 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4407
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004408 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4409 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4410 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4411 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4412 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4413 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4414 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4415
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004416 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4417 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4418 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4419 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4420 continues.
4421
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004422 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4423 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4424 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4425 the actions evaluation continues.
4426
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004427 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4428 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4429 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4430 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4431 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4432 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4433 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4434 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4435 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4436 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4437 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4438 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4439 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4440 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4441 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4442 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4443
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004444 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4445
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004446 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004447 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4448 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004449 rules.
4450
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004451 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4452 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4453 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4454 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4455
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004456 Example:
4457 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4458
4459 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4460
4461 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4462 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4463
4464 Example:
4465 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4466
4467 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4468
4469 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4470 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4471
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004472 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4473 ACL usage.
4474
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004475
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004476http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4477 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4478
4479 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4480 yes | no | yes | yes
4481
4482 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4483 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4484 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4485 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4486 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4487 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4488
4489 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4490
4491 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4492 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4493 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4494 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4495 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4496 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4497 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4498 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4499 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4500 not checking any request past the first one.
4501
4502 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4503 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4504 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4505 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4506 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4507 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4508 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4509
4510 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4511 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4512 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4513 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4514 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4515 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4516 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4517 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4518 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4519 downsides of rare connection failures.
4520
4521 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4522 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4523 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4524 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4525 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4526 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4527 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4528 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4529 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4530 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4531 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4532 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4533
4534 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4535 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4536 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4537 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4538
4539 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4540 and are never shared ;
4541
4542 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4543 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4544 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4545 and are never shared ;
4546
4547 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4548 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4549 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4550
4551 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4552 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4553 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4554
4555 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4556
4557
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004558http-send-name-header [<header>]
4559 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4560
4561 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4562 yes | no | yes | yes
4563
4564 Arguments :
4565
4566 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4567
4568 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4569 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4570 is added with the header string proved.
4571
4572 See also : "server"
4573
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004574id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004575 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4577 no | yes | yes | yes
4578 Arguments : none
4579
4580 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4581 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4582 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004583
4584
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004585ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4586 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4587 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4588 no | yes | yes | yes
4589
4590 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4591 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4592 and running).
4593
4594 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4595 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4596 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004597 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004598 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4599
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004600 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4601 "unless" condition is met.
4602
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004603 Example:
4604 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4605 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4606 ignore-persist if url_static
4607
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004608 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4609
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004610load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4611 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4612 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4613 yes | no | yes | yes
4614
4615 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4616 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4617 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4618 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4619 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4620 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4621 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4622 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4623
4624 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4625 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004626 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004627
4628 Arguments:
4629 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4630 named "server-state-file".
4631
4632 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4633 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4634 name is used as a file name.
4635
4636 none don't load any stat for this backend
4637
4638 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004639 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4640 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4641 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4642 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4643 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004644
4645 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4646 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4647
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004648 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004649
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004650 global
4651 stats socket /tmp/socket
4652 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004653
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004654 defaults
4655 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004656
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004657 backend bk
4658 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4659 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004660
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004661
4662 Then one can run :
4663
4664 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4665
4666 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4667
4668 1
4669 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4670 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4671 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4672
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004673 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004674
4675 global
4676 stats socket /tmp/socket
4677 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4678
4679 defaults
4680 load-server-state-from-file local
4681
4682 backend bk
4683 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4684 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4685
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004686
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004687 Then one can run :
4688
4689 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4690
4691 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4692
4693 1
4694 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4695 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4696 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4697
4698 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4699 "show servers state"
4700
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004701
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004702log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004703log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004704no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004705 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4707 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004708
4709 Prefix :
4710 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4711 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4712 prefix does not allow arguments.
4713
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004714 Arguments :
4715 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4716 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4717 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4718 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4719 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4720 parameter.
4721
4722 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4723 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4724
4725 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4726 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4727 standard syslog port).
4728
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004729 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4730 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4731 standard syslog port).
4732
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004733 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4734 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4735 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4736 appropriately writeable).
4737
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004738 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4739 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004740
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004741 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4742 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4743 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4744 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4745 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4746 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4747 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4748 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4749 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4750 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4751 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4752
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004753 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4754
4755 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4756 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4757 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4758
4759 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4760 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4761 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004762 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4763 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4764 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4765 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4766 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004767
4768 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4769
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004770 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4771 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4772 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004773
4774 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4775 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4776 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4777 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4778
4779 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4780 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004781
4782 Example :
4783 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004784 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4785 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004786 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004787
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004788
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004789log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004790 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4791 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4792 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004793
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004794 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4795 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4796 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4797 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4798 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004799
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02004800 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
4801 "option httplog" directives.
4802
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004803log-format-sd <string>
4804 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4805 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4806 yes | yes | yes | no
4807
4808 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4809 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4810 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4811 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4812 which covers the log format string in depth.
4813
4814 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4815 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4816
4817 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4818 log format to "rfc5424".
4819
4820 Example :
4821 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4822
4823
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004824log-tag <string>
4825 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4826 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4827 yes | yes | yes | yes
4828
4829 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4830 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4831 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4832 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4833 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4834 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4835 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4836 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4837 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004838
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004839max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4840 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4841 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4842 yes | no | yes | yes
4843
4844 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4845 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4846 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4847 servers.
4848
4849 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4850 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4851 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4852 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4853 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4854 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4855 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4856 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4857 picking a different server.
4858
4859 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4860 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4861 even if they have to be queued.
4862
4863 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4864 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4865
4866
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004867maxconn <conns>
4868 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4869 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4870 yes | yes | yes | no
4871 Arguments :
4872 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4873 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4874 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4875 closes.
4876
4877 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4878 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4879 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4880 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004881 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4882 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4883 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4884 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004885
4886 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4887 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4888 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4889
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004890 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4891
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004892 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4893
4894
4895mode { tcp|http|health }
4896 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4898 yes | yes | yes | yes
4899 Arguments :
4900 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4901 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4902 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4903 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4904
4905 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4906 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4907 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4908 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4909 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4910
4911 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004912 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4913 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4914 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4915 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4916 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4917 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4918 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004919
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004920 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4921 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4922 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004923
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004924 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004925 defaults http_instances
4926 mode http
4927
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004928 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004929
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004930
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004931monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004932 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4934 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004935 Arguments :
4936 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4937 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004938 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004939 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4940 backend and its backup.
4941
4942 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4943 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4944 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4945 servers in a list of backends.
4946
4947 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4948 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4949 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4950 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4951 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4952 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4953 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004954 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4955 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004956
4957 Example:
4958 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004959 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004960 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4961 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4962 monitor-uri /site_alive
4963 monitor fail if site_dead
4964
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004965 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004966
4967
4968monitor-net <source>
4969 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4970 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4971 yes | yes | yes | no
4972 Arguments :
4973 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4974 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4975 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4976 followed by a mask.
4977
4978 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4979 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004980 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004981 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4982
4983 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4984 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4985 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4986 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004987 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4988 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4989 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004990
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004991 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4992 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4993 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4994 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4995 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4996 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004997
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004998 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4999 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005000
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005001 Example :
5002 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5003 frontend www
5004 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5005
5006 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5007
5008
5009monitor-uri <uri>
5010 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5012 yes | yes | yes | no
5013 Arguments :
5014 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5015 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5016
5017 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5018 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5019 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5020 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5021 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5022 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5023 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5024 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5025
5026 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
5027 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5028 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5029 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5030 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5031 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
5032
5033 Example :
5034 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5035 frontend www
5036 mode http
5037 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5038
5039 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5040
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005041
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005042option abortonclose
5043no option abortonclose
5044 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5046 yes | no | yes | yes
5047 Arguments : none
5048
5049 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5050 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5051 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5052 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005053 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005054 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5055 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5056 encountered while delivering the response.
5057
5058 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5059 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5060 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5061 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5062 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5063 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005064 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005065 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005066 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005067 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5068 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5069 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5070
5071 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5072 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5073 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5074 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5075 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5076 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5077 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5078 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005079 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005080
5081 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5082 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5083
5084 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5085
5086
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005087option accept-invalid-http-request
5088no option accept-invalid-http-request
5089 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5091 yes | yes | yes | no
5092 Arguments : none
5093
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005094 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005095 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5096 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5097 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5098 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5099 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5100 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5101 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005102 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5103 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5104 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5105 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5106 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005107 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005108 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5109 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5110 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005111
5112 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5113 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5114 been confirmed.
5115
5116 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5117 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005118 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5119 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005120 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5121
5122 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5123 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5124
5125 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5126 stats socket.
5127
5128
5129option accept-invalid-http-response
5130no option accept-invalid-http-response
5131 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5132 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5133 yes | no | yes | yes
5134 Arguments : none
5135
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005136 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005137 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5138 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5139 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5140 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5141 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5142 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5143 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005144 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5145 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5146 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005147
5148 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5149 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5150 been confirmed.
5151
5152 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5153 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5154 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5155 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5156
5157 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5158 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5159
5160 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5161 stats socket.
5162
5163
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005164option allbackups
5165no option allbackups
5166 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5168 yes | no | yes | yes
5169 Arguments : none
5170
5171 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5172 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5173 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5174 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5175 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5176 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5177 order between the backup servers anymore.
5178
5179 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5180 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5181
5182 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5183 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5184
5185
5186option checkcache
5187no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005188 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5190 yes | no | yes | yes
5191 Arguments : none
5192
5193 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5194 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005195 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005196 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5197 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005198 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005199
5200 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005201 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005202 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005203 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5204 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005205 to the client are :
5206 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005207 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005208 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005209 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5210 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5211 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5212 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5213 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5214 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5215 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5216 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5217 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5218 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5219 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5220
5221 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005222 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005223 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005224 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005225 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5226
5227 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5228 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005229 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005230 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5231
5232 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5233 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5234
5235
5236option clitcpka
5237no option clitcpka
5238 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5240 yes | yes | yes | no
5241 Arguments : none
5242
5243 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5244 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5245 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5246 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5247
5248 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5249 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5250 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5251 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5252
5253 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5254 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5255 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5256 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5257 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5258
5259 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5260
5261 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5262 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5263 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5264
5265 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5266 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5267
5268 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5269
5270
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005271option contstats
5272 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5274 yes | yes | yes | no
5275 Arguments : none
5276
5277 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5278 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5279 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5280 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005281 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5282 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5283 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5284 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5285 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005286
5287
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005288option dontlog-normal
5289no option dontlog-normal
5290 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5292 yes | yes | yes | no
5293 Arguments : none
5294
5295 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5296 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5297 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5298 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5299 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5300 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5301 logged.
5302
5303 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5304 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5305 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5306
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005307 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005308 logging.
5309
5310
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005311option dontlognull
5312no option dontlognull
5313 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5315 yes | yes | yes | no
5316 Arguments : none
5317
5318 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5319 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5320 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5321 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5322 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5323 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005324 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5325 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5326 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005327
5328 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5329 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5330 would not be logged.
5331
5332 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5333 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5334
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005335 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5336 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005337
5338
5339option forceclose
5340no option forceclose
5341 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005343 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005344 Arguments : none
5345
5346 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5347 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5348 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5349 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5350 global session times in the logs.
5351
5352 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005353 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005354 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005355
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005356 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5357 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5358 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5359
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005360 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5361 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005362
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005363 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5364 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5365
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005366 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005367
5368
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005369option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005370 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5372 yes | yes | yes | yes
5373 Arguments :
5374 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5375 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005376 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005377 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005378
5379 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5380 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5381 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5382 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5383 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5384 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5385 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005386 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5387 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5388 possible that the client has already brought one.
5389
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005390 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005391 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005392 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5393 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005394 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5395 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005396
5397 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5398 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5399 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5400 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5401 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5402 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5403 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5404
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005405 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5406 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5407 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5408 are under the control of the end-user.
5409
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005410 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005411 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5412 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005413 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5414 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5415 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005416
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005417 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005418 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5419 frontend www
5420 mode http
5421 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5422
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005423 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5424 backend www
5425 mode http
5426 option forwardfor header X-Client
5427
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005428 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005429 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005430
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005431
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005432option http-buffer-request
5433no option http-buffer-request
5434 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5436 yes | yes | yes | yes
5437 Arguments : none
5438
5439 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5440 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5441 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5442 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5443 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5444 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5445 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5446 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005447 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005448 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5449 default.
5450
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005451 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005452
5453
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005454option http-ignore-probes
5455no option http-ignore-probes
5456 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5458 yes | yes | yes | no
5459 Arguments : none
5460
5461 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5462 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5463 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5464 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5465 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5466 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5467 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5468 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5469 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5470 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5471 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5472 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5473
5474 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5475 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5476 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5477 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5478 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5479 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5480 are often the only way to detect them.
5481
5482 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5483 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5484
5485 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5486
5487
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005488option http-keep-alive
5489no option http-keep-alive
5490 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5492 yes | yes | yes | yes
5493 Arguments : none
5494
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005495 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5496 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5497 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5498 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5499 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5500 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5501 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5502
5503 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5504 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005505 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5506 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5507 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5508 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5509 situations where this option may be useful :
5510
5511 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5512 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5513
5514 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5515 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5516
5517 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5518 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5519 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5520 request.
5521
5522 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5523 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005524 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5525 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5526 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005527
5528 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5529 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5530
5531 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5532 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5533 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5534 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5535 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5536 not set.
5537
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005538 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5539 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005540 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005541 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005542
5543 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005544 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5545 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005546
5547
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005548option http-no-delay
5549no option http-no-delay
5550 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5552 yes | yes | yes | yes
5553 Arguments : none
5554
5555 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5556 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5557 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5558 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5559 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5560 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5561 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5562 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5563 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5564 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5565 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5566 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5567 affected.
5568
5569 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5570 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5571 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5572 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5573 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5574 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5575 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5576 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5577 latency environments.
5578
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005579 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5580
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005581
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005582option http-pretend-keepalive
5583no option http-pretend-keepalive
5584 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5585 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5586 yes | yes | yes | yes
5587 Arguments : none
5588
5589 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5590 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5591 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5592 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5593 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5594 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5595 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5596 consider the response complete.
5597
5598 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5599 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5600 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5601 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5602 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5603 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5604
5605 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5606 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5607 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5608 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5609 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5610 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5611 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5612
5613 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5614 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005615 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005616 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5617 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005618
5619 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5620 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5621
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005622 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5623 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005624
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005625
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005626option http-server-close
5627no option http-server-close
5628 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5630 yes | yes | yes | yes
5631 Arguments : none
5632
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005633 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5634 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5635 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5636 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5637 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5638 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5639 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5640 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5641 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5642 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5643 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005644 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005645 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5646 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5647 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5648 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005649
5650 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5651 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5652 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5653 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005654 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5655 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005656
5657 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5658 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005659 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5660 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005661 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5662 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005663
5664 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5665 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5666
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005667 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005668 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5669 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005670
5671
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005672option http-tunnel
5673no option http-tunnel
5674 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5676 yes | yes | yes | yes
5677 Arguments : none
5678
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005679 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5680 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5681 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5682 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5683 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5684 "option http-tunnel".
5685
5686 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005687 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005688 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5689 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5690 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5691 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5692 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5693 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5694 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005695
5696 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5697 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5698
5699 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5700 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5701 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5702
5703
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005704option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005705no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005706 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5708 yes | yes | yes | no
5709 Arguments : none
5710
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005711 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005712 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5713 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5714 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5715 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5716 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5717 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5718
5719 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5720 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005721 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5722 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5723 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005724
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005725 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5726 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5727 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5728 front of an existing proxy.
5729
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005730 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5731
5732 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5733 http-server-close".
5734
5735
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005736option httpchk
5737option httpchk <uri>
5738option httpchk <method> <uri>
5739option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5740 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5742 yes | no | yes | yes
5743 Arguments :
5744 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5745 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5746 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5747 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5748 ones.
5749
5750 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5751 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5752 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5753
5754 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5755 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5756 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5757 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5758 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5759
5760 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5761 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5762 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5763 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5764 the lack of any response.
5765
5766 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5767
5768 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5769 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5770 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5771
5772 Examples :
5773 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5774 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5775 backend https_relay
5776 mode tcp
5777 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5778 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5779
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005780 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5781 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5782 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005783
5784
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005785option httpclose
5786no option httpclose
5787 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5789 yes | yes | yes | yes
5790 Arguments : none
5791
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005792 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5793 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5794 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5795 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005796 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005797 "option http-tunnel".
5798
5799 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5800 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5801 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5802 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5803 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5804 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5805 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5806 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005807
5808 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005809 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005810 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5811 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5812 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5813 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5814 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005815
5816 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5817 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005818 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5819 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005820 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5821 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005822
5823 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5824 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5825
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005826 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5827 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005828
5829
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005830option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005831 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5833 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005834 Arguments :
5835 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5836 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5837 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5838 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5839 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005840
5841 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5842 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5843 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5844 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5845 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5846 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5847 ports.
5848
5849 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5850
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005851 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5852 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005853
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005854 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
5855
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005856 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005857
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005858
5859option http_proxy
5860no option http_proxy
5861 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5863 yes | yes | yes | yes
5864 Arguments : none
5865
5866 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5867 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5868 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5869 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5870 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5871
5872 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5873 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005874 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5875 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005876
5877 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5878 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5879
5880 Example :
5881 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5882 backend direct_forward
5883 option httpclose
5884 option http_proxy
5885
5886 See also : "option httpclose"
5887
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005888
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005889option independent-streams
5890no option independent-streams
5891 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5893 yes | yes | yes | yes
5894 Arguments : none
5895
5896 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5897 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5898 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5899 receive data or not.
5900
5901 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5902 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5903 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5904 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5905 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5906 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5907 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5908 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5909 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5910 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5911 socket buffers.
5912
5913 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5914 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5915 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5916 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5917 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5918
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005919 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005920 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5921 deprecated.
5922
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005923 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005924
5925
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005926option ldap-check
5927 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5929 yes | no | yes | yes
5930 Arguments : none
5931
5932 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5933 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5934 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5935 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5936
5937 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5938 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5939
5940 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5941 configure it.
5942
5943 Example :
5944 option ldap-check
5945
5946 See also : "option httpchk"
5947
5948
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005949option external-check
5950 Use external processes for server health checks
5951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5952 yes | no | yes | yes
5953
5954 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5955 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5956 command".
5957
5958 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5959
5960 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5961
5962
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005963option log-health-checks
5964no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005965 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5967 yes | no | yes | yes
5968 Arguments : none
5969
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005970 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5971 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5972 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005973
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005974 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5975 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5976 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5977 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5978 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5979
5980 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5981 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005982
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005983 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5984 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5985 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005986
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005987
5988option log-separate-errors
5989no option log-separate-errors
5990 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5992 yes | yes | yes | no
5993 Arguments : none
5994
5995 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5996 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5997 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5998 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5999 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6000 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6001 provides very important information.
6002
6003 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6004 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6005 error logs.
6006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006007 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006008 logging.
6009
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006010
6011option logasap
6012no option logasap
6013 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6014 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6015 yes | yes | yes | no
6016 Arguments : none
6017
6018 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6019 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6020 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6021 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6022 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6023 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6024 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006025 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006026 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6027 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6028
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006029 Examples :
6030 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6031 mode http
6032 option httplog
6033 option logasap
6034 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6035
6036 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6037 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6038 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6039 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6040
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006041 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006042 logging.
6043
6044
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006045option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006046 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6048 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006049 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006050 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6051 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006052 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006053
6054 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6055 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6056 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6057 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6058 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6059 in the MySQL table, like this :
6060
6061 USE mysql;
6062 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6063 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6064
6065 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6066 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6067 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6068 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6069 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6070 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6071 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6072 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6073 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6074
6075 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6076 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006077
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006078 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006079
6080 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6081 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6082 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6083 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006084 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6085 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006086
6087 See also: "option httpchk"
6088
6089
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006090option nolinger
6091no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006092 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006093 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6094 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006095 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006096
6097 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6098 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6099 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6100 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6101 connections.
6102
6103 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6104 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6105 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6106 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6107 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6108 this too.
6109
6110 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6111 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6112 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6113
6114 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6115 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6116 for servers.
6117
6118 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6119 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6120
6121
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006122option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6123 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6125 yes | yes | yes | yes
6126 Arguments :
6127 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6128 matching <network>
6129 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6130 header name.
6131
6132 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6133 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6134 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6135 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6136 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6137 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6138 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6139 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6140 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6141 possible that the client has already brought one.
6142
6143 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6144 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6145 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6146 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6147 header and requires different one.
6148
6149 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6150 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6151 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6152 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6153 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6154 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6155 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6156
6157 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6158 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6159 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6160 both are defined.
6161
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006162 Examples :
6163 # Original Destination address
6164 frontend www
6165 mode http
6166 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6167
6168 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6169 backend www
6170 mode http
6171 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6172
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006173 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6174 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006175
6176
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006177option persist
6178no option persist
6179 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6180 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6181 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006182 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006183
6184 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6185 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6186 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6187 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6188 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6189 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6190 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6191 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6192 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6193 redirected to another valid server.
6194
6195 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6196 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6197
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006198 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006199
6200
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006201option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6202 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6204 yes | no | yes | yes
6205 Arguments :
6206 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6207 PostgreSQL server.
6208
6209 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6210 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6211 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6212 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6213
6214 See also: "option httpchk"
6215
6216
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006217option prefer-last-server
6218no option prefer-last-server
6219 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6220 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6221 yes | no | yes | yes
6222 Arguments : none
6223
6224 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6225 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6226 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6227 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6228 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6229 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6230 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6231 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6232 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006233 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6234 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6235 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6236 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6237 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6238 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6239 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006240
6241 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6242 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6243
6244 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6245
6246
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006247option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006248option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006249no option redispatch
6250 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6251 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6252 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006253 Arguments :
6254 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6255 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6256 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6257 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6258 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6259 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6260 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6261 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6262 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6263
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006264
6265 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6266 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6267 be able to access the service anymore.
6268
6269 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6270 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6271
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006272 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006273 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6274 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006275
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006276 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6277 "redisp" keywords.
6278
6279 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6280 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6281
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006282 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006283
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006284
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006285option redis-check
6286 Use redis health checks for server testing
6287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6288 yes | no | yes | yes
6289 Arguments : none
6290
6291 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6292 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6293 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6294 find the "+PONG" response message.
6295
6296 Example :
6297 option redis-check
6298
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006299 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006300
6301
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006302option smtpchk
6303option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6304 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6306 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006307 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006308 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6309 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6310 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6311
6312 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6313 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6314 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6315
6316 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6317 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6318 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6319 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6320 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6321 dead server.
6322
6323 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6324 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6325 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6326 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6327
6328 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6329 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6330 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6331 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006332 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006333
6334 Example :
6335 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6336
6337 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6338
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006339
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006340option socket-stats
6341no option socket-stats
6342
6343 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6344 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6345 yes | yes | yes | no
6346
6347 Arguments : none
6348
6349
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006350option splice-auto
6351no option splice-auto
6352 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6354 yes | yes | yes | yes
6355 Arguments : none
6356
6357 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6358 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6359 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6360 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006361 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006362 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6363 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6364 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6365 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6366
6367 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6368 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6369 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6370 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6371 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6372 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6373 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6374 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6375 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6376 keyword.
6377
6378 Example :
6379 option splice-auto
6380
6381 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6382 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6383
6384 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6385 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6386
6387
6388option splice-request
6389no option splice-request
6390 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6392 yes | yes | yes | yes
6393 Arguments : none
6394
6395 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006396 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006397 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6398 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6399 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6400 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6401
6402 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6403
6404 Example :
6405 option splice-request
6406
6407 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6408 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6409
6410 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6411 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6412
6413
6414option splice-response
6415no option splice-response
6416 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6418 yes | yes | yes | yes
6419 Arguments : none
6420
6421 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006422 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006423 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6424 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6425 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6426 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6427
6428 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6429
6430 Example :
6431 option splice-response
6432
6433 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6434 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6435
6436 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6437 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6438
6439
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006440option spop-check
6441 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6443 no | no | no | yes
6444 Arguments : none
6445
6446 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6447 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6448 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6449 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6450
6451 Example :
6452 option spop-check
6453
6454 See also : "option httpchk"
6455
6456
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006457option srvtcpka
6458no option srvtcpka
6459 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6461 yes | no | yes | yes
6462 Arguments : none
6463
6464 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6465 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6466 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6467 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6468
6469 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6470 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6471 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6472 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6473
6474 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6475 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6476 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6477 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6478 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6479
6480 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6481
6482 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6483 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6484 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6485
6486 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6487 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6488
6489 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6490
6491
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006492option ssl-hello-chk
6493 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6495 yes | no | yes | yes
6496 Arguments : none
6497
6498 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6499 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6500 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6501 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6502 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6503 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6504 hello message.
6505
6506 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6507 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6508 messages, which is appreciable.
6509
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006510 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6511 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6512 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006513
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006514 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6515
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006516
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006517option tcp-check
6518 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6519 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6520 yes | no | yes | yes
6521
6522 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6523 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6524
6525 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6526 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6527 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6528
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006529 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006530 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6531 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6532 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6533 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6534 only.
6535
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006536 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006537 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6538 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6539 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6540 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6541
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006542 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006543 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6544 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006545 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006546 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6547 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6548 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6549 the respective protocols.
6550 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6551 analysed.
6552
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006553 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6554 script.
6555
6556 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6557 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6558 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6559 The "comment" is of course optional.
6560
6561
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006562 Examples :
6563 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6564 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006565 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006566
6567 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6568 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006569 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006570
6571 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6572 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006573 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006574 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006575 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006576 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006577 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006578 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006579 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6580 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006581 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006582 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6583 tcp-check expect string +OK
6584
6585 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6586 (send many headers before analyzing)
6587 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006588 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006589 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6590 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6591 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6592 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006593 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006594
6595
6596 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6597
6598
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006599option tcp-smart-accept
6600no option tcp-smart-accept
6601 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6603 yes | yes | yes | no
6604 Arguments : none
6605
6606 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6607 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6608 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6609 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6610 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6611 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6612
6613 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6614 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6615 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6616 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6617
6618 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6619 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6620 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6621 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6622
6623 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6624 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6625 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6626
6627 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6628 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6629 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6630
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006631 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6632
6633
6634option tcp-smart-connect
6635no option tcp-smart-connect
6636 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6638 yes | no | yes | yes
6639 Arguments : none
6640
6641 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6642 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6643 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6644 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6645 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6646
6647 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6648 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6649 complex.
6650
6651 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6652 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6653 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6654
6655 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6656 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6657
6658 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6659
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006660
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006661option tcpka
6662 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6664 yes | yes | yes | yes
6665 Arguments : none
6666
6667 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6668 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6669 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6670 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6671
6672 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6673 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6674 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6675 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6676
6677 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6678 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6679 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6680 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6681 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6682
6683 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6684
6685 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6686 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6687 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6688 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6689 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6690 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6691 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6692 backends.
6693
6694 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6695
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006696
6697option tcplog
6698 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6700 yes | yes | yes | yes
6701 Arguments : none
6702
6703 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6704 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6705 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6706 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6707 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6708 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6709 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6710 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6711
6712 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6713
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006714 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6715
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006716 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006717
6718
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006719option transparent
6720no option transparent
6721 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006723 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006724 Arguments : none
6725
6726 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6727 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6728 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6729 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6730 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6731 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6732 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6733 appropriate server.
6734
6735 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6736 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6737
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006738 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006739 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006740
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006741
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006742external-check command <command>
6743 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6745 yes | no | yes | yes
6746
6747 Arguments :
6748 <command> is the external command to run
6749
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006750 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6751
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006752 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006753
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006754 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6755 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6756 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6757 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6758 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6759 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006760
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006761 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6762
6763 Environment variables :
6764 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6765 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6766
6767 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6768
6769 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6770
6771 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6772 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6773 for a UNIX socket).
6774
6775 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6776
6777 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6778
6779 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6780
6781 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6782
6783 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6784
6785 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6786 socket).
6787
6788 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6789 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6790
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006791 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6792 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6793 failed.
6794
6795 Example :
6796 external-check command /bin/true
6797
6798 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6799
6800
6801external-check path <path>
6802 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6804 yes | no | yes | yes
6805
6806 Arguments :
6807 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6808
6809 The default path is "".
6810
6811 Example :
6812 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6813
6814 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6815 "external-check command"
6816
6817
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006818persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006819persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006820 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6822 yes | no | yes | yes
6823 Arguments :
6824 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006825 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6826 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006827
6828 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6829 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6830 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6831 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6832 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6833 forwarded to this server.
6834
6835 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6836 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6837 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006838 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006839 a single "listen" section.
6840
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006841 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6842 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6843 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6844
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006845 Example :
6846 listen tse-farm
6847 bind :3389
6848 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6849 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6850 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6851 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6852 persist rdp-cookie
6853 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006854 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006855 balance rdp-cookie
6856 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6857 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6858
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006859 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6860 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006861
6862
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006863rate-limit sessions <rate>
6864 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6866 yes | yes | yes | no
6867 Arguments :
6868 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6869 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6870
6871 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6872 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6873 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6874 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6875 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6876 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6877
6878 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6879 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6880 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6881 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6882
6883 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6884 listen smtp
6885 mode tcp
6886 bind :25
6887 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006888 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006889
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006890 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6891 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6892 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006893
6894 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6895
6896
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006897redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6898redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6899redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006900 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6902 no | yes | yes | yes
6903
6904 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006905 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006906
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006907 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006908 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006909 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6910 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6911 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006912
6913 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6914 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6915 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6916 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6917 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006918 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6919 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6920 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6921 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006922
6923 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6924 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6925 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6926 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6927 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6928 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006929 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006930 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006931 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6932 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6933 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006934
6935 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006936 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6937 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6938 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006939 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006940 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6941 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6942 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6943 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006944
6945 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6946 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6947
6948 - "drop-query"
6949 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6950 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6951 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6952 with a location-type redirect.
6953
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006954 - "append-slash"
6955 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6956 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6957 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6958 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6959
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006960 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6961 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6962 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6963 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6964 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6965 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6966 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6967
6968 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6969 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6970 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6971 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6972 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6973 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6974 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006975
6976 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6977 acl clear dst_port 80
6978 acl secure dst_port 8080
6979 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006980 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006981 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006982 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6983
6984 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006985 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6986 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6987 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006988 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006989
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006990 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6991 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6992 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6993
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006994 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006995 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006996
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006997 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006998 http-request redirect code 301 location \
6999 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7000 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007001
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007002 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007003
7004
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007005redisp (deprecated)
7006redispatch (deprecated)
7007 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7008 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7009 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007010 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007011
7012 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7013 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7014 be able to access the service anymore.
7015
7016 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7017 redistribute them to a working server.
7018
7019 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7020 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7021 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007022
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007023 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7024 "option redispatch" instead.
7025
7026 See also : "option redispatch"
7027
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007028
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007029reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007030 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7032 no | yes | yes | yes
7033 Arguments :
7034 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7035 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007036 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007037
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007038 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7039 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7040
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007041 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7042 the last header of an HTTP request.
7043
7044 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7045 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7046 responses.
7047
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007048 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7049 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7050 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7051
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007052 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7053 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007054
7055
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007056reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7057reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007058 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7060 no | yes | yes | yes
7061 Arguments :
7062 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7063 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7064 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7065 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7066 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7067 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7068 ignores case.
7069
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007070 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7071 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7072
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007073 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7074 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7075 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7076 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007077 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007078
7079 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7080 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7081
7082 Example :
7083 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7084 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7085 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7086
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007087 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7088 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007089
7090
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007091reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7092reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007093 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7095 no | yes | yes | yes
7096 Arguments :
7097 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7098 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7099 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7100 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7101 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7102 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7103
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007104 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7105 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7106
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007107 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7108 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7109 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7110 next servers.
7111
7112 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7113 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7114 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7115
7116 Example :
7117 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7118 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7119 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7120
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007121 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7122 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007123
7124
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007125reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7126reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007127 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7129 no | yes | yes | yes
7130 Arguments :
7131 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7132 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7133 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7134 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7135 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7136 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7137 case.
7138
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007139 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7140 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7141
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007142 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7143 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7144 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7145 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007146 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007147
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007148 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007149 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007150 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007151
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007152 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7153 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7154
7155 Example :
7156 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7157 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7158 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7159
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007160 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7161 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007162
7163
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007164reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7165reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007166 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7167 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7168 no | yes | yes | yes
7169 Arguments :
7170 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7171 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7172 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7173 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7174 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7175 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7176 case.
7177
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007178 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7179 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7180
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007181 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7182 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7183 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7184 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7185
7186 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7187 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7188
7189 Example :
7190 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7191 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7192 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7193 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7194
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007195 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7196 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007197
7198
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007199reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7200reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007201 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7203 no | yes | yes | yes
7204 Arguments :
7205 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7206 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7207 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7208 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7209 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7210 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7211
7212 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7213 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7214 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7215 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007216 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007217
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007218 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7219 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7220
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007221 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7222 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7223 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7224
7225 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7226 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7227 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7228 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7229 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7230
7231 Example :
7232 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007233 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007234 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7235 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7236
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007237 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7238 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007239
7240
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007241reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7242reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007243 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7245 no | yes | yes | yes
7246 Arguments :
7247 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7248 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7249 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7250 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7251 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7252 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7253 ignores case.
7254
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007255 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7256 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7257
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007258 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7259 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007260 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7261 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7262 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007263 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7264 not set.
7265
7266 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7267 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7268 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7269 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7270 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7271
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007272 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007273 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7274 # block all others.
7275 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7276 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7277
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007278 # block bad guys
7279 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7280 reqitarpit . if badguys
7281
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007282 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7283 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007284
7285
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007286retries <value>
7287 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7288 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7289 yes | no | yes | yes
7290 Arguments :
7291 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7292 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7293 default value is 3.
7294
7295 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7296 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7297 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7298
7299 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007300 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7301 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007302
7303 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7304 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7305
7306 See also : "option redispatch"
7307
7308
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007309rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007310 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7312 no | yes | yes | yes
7313 Arguments :
7314 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7315 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007316 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007317
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007318 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7319 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7320
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007321 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7322 the last header of an HTTP response.
7323
7324 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7325 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7326 responses.
7327
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007328 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7329 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007330
7331
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007332rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7333rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007334 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7336 no | yes | yes | yes
7337 Arguments :
7338 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7339 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7340 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7341 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7342 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7343 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7344 ignores case.
7345
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007346 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7347 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7348
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007349 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7350 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007351 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007352 client.
7353
7354 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7355 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7356 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7357
7358 Example :
7359 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007360 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007361
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007362 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7363 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007364
7365
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007366rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7367rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007368 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7370 no | yes | yes | yes
7371 Arguments :
7372 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7373 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7374 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7375 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7376 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7377 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7378 ignores case.
7379
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007380 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7381 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7382
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007383 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7384 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7385 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7386 case-sensitive.
7387
7388 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007389 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7390 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7391 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007392
7393 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7394 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7395
7396 Example :
7397 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7398 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7399
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007400 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7401 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007402
7403
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007404rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7405rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007406 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7408 no | yes | yes | yes
7409 Arguments :
7410 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7411 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7412 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7413 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7414 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7415 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7416 ignores case.
7417
7418 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7419 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7420 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7421 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007422 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007423
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007424 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7425 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7426
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007427 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7428 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7429 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7430
7431 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7432 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7433 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7434 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7435 are not case-sensitive.
7436
7437 Example :
7438 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7439 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7440
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007441 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7442 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007443
7444
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007445server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007446 Declare a server in a backend
7447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7448 no | no | yes | yes
7449 Arguments :
7450 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007451 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007452 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007453
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007454 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7455 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7456 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7457 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007458 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7459 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7460 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7461 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7462 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007463 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7464 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7465 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7466 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7467 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7468 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7469 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007470 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007471 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7472 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007473 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7474 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007475
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007476 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007477 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7478 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7479 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7480 adding this value to the client's port.
7481
7482 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7483 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007484 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007485
7486 Examples :
7487 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7488 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007489 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007490 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7491 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7492 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007493
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007494 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7495 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7496 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7497 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7498 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7499
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007500 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7501 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007502
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007503server-state-file-name [<file>]
7504 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7505 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7506 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7507 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7508 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7509 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7510
7511 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7512 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7513
7514 global
7515 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7516
7517 backend bk
7518 load-server-state-from-file
7519
7520 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7521 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007522
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007523server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7524 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7525 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7527 no | no | yes | yes
7528
7529 Arguments:
7530 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7531
7532 <num | range>
7533 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7534 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7535 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7536 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7537
7538 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7539
7540 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7541
7542 <params*>
7543 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7544 keyword.
7545
7546 Examples:
7547 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7548 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7549 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7550
7551 # or
7552 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7553
7554 # would be equivalent to:
7555 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7556 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7557 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7558
7559
7560
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007561source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007562source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007563source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007564 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7566 yes | no | yes | yes
7567 Arguments :
7568 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7569 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007570
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007571 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007572 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7573 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7574 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7575 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7576 supported prefixes are :
7577 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7578 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7579 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007580 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007581 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7582 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007583
7584 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7585 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007586 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7587 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7588 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007589
7590 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7591 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7592 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7593 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7594 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7595 <addr>.
7596
7597 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7598 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7599 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7600 port.
7601
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007602 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7603 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7604 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7605 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007606 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007607 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7608 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7609 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7610 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7611 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7612 HTTP header.
7613
7614 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7615 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007616 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007617 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7618 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7619 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7620 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7621 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7622 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7623 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7624
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007625 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7626 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7627 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7628 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7629 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7630 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7631
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007632 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7633 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7634 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7635 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7636
7637 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7638 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7639 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7640 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7641 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7642 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7643
7644 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7645 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7646 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7647 there are two methods :
7648
7649 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7650 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7651 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7652 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7653 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7654 of the client ranges may be used.
7655
7656 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7657 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7658 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7659 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7660 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7661 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7662 same session.
7663
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007664 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7665 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7666 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007667 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007668
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007669 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7670
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007671 Examples :
7672 backend private
7673 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7674 source 192.168.1.200
7675
7676 backend transparent_ssl1
7677 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7678 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7679
7680 backend transparent_ssl2
7681 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7682 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7683 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7684
7685 backend transparent_ssl3
7686 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7687 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7688 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7689
7690 backend transparent_smtp
7691 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7692 # with Tproxy version 4.
7693 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7694
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007695 backend transparent_http
7696 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7697 # proxy.
7698 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7699
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007700 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007701 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7702
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007703
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007704srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7705 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7707 yes | no | yes | yes
7708 Arguments :
7709 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7710 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7711 as explained at the top of this document.
7712
7713 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7714 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7715 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7716 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7717 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7718 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7719 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7720
7721 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7722 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7723 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7724 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7725 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007726 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007727 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007728 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007729
7730 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7731 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7732 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7733 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7734 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7735 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7736
7737 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7738 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7739
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007740 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7741 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007742
7743
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007744stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7745 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007747 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007748
7749 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7750 matched.
7751
7752 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7753 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7754
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007755 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7756 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7757 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7758
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007759 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7760 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7761 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7762 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007763
7764 Example :
7765 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7766 backend stats_localhost
7767 stats enable
7768 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7769
7770 Example :
7771 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7772 backend stats_auth
7773 stats enable
7774 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7775 stats admin if TRUE
7776
7777 Example :
7778 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7779 userlist stats-auth
7780 group admin users admin
7781 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7782 group readonly users haproxy
7783 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7784
7785 backend stats_auth
7786 stats enable
7787 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7788 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7789 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7790 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7791
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007792 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7793 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7794 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007795
7796
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007797stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7798 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007800 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007801 Arguments :
7802 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7803
7804 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7805
7806 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7807 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7808 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7809 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7810 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7811 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7812
7813 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7814 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7815 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007816 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007817
7818 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7819 report using "stats scope".
7820
7821 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7822 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7823 unobvious parameters.
7824
7825 Example :
7826 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7827 backend public_www
7828 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7829 stats enable
7830 stats hide-version
7831 stats scope .
7832 stats uri /admin?stats
7833 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7834 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7835 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7836
7837 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7838 backend private_monitoring
7839 stats enable
7840 stats uri /admin?stats
7841 stats refresh 5s
7842
7843 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7844
7845
7846stats enable
7847 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007849 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007850 Arguments : none
7851
7852 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7853 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7854 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7855 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7856 - stats auth : no authentication
7857 - stats scope : no restriction
7858
7859 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7860 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7861 unobvious parameters.
7862
7863 Example :
7864 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7865 backend public_www
7866 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7867 stats enable
7868 stats hide-version
7869 stats scope .
7870 stats uri /admin?stats
7871 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7872 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7873 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7874
7875 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7876 backend private_monitoring
7877 stats enable
7878 stats uri /admin?stats
7879 stats refresh 5s
7880
7881 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7882
7883
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007884stats hide-version
7885 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007887 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007888 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007889
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007890 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7891 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7892 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7893 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7894 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7895 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007896
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007897 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7898 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7899 unobvious parameters.
7900
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007901 Example :
7902 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7903 backend public_www
7904 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007905 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007906 stats hide-version
7907 stats scope .
7908 stats uri /admin?stats
7909 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7910 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7911 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007912
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007913 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7914 backend private_monitoring
7915 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007916 stats uri /admin?stats
7917 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007918
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007919 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007920
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007921
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007922stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7923 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7924 Access control for statistics
7925
7926 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7927 no | no | yes | yes
7928
7929 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7930 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7931 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7932 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7933 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7934 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7935
7936 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7937 instance.
7938
7939 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7940 about ACL usage.
7941
7942
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007943stats realm <realm>
7944 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007946 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007947 Arguments :
7948 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7949 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7950 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7951
7952 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7953 using a backslash ('\').
7954
7955 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7956 only related to authentication.
7957
7958 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7959 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7960 unobvious parameters.
7961
7962 Example :
7963 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7964 backend public_www
7965 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7966 stats enable
7967 stats hide-version
7968 stats scope .
7969 stats uri /admin?stats
7970 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7971 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7972 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7973
7974 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7975 backend private_monitoring
7976 stats enable
7977 stats uri /admin?stats
7978 stats refresh 5s
7979
7980 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7981
7982
7983stats refresh <delay>
7984 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007986 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007987 Arguments :
7988 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7989 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7990 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7991 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7992 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7993 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7994
7995 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7996 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7997 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7998 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7999
8000 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8001 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8002 unobvious parameters.
8003
8004 Example :
8005 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8006 backend public_www
8007 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8008 stats enable
8009 stats hide-version
8010 stats scope .
8011 stats uri /admin?stats
8012 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8013 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8014 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8015
8016 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8017 backend private_monitoring
8018 stats enable
8019 stats uri /admin?stats
8020 stats refresh 5s
8021
8022 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8023
8024
8025stats scope { <name> | "." }
8026 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008028 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008029 Arguments :
8030 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8031 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8032 section in which the statement appears.
8033
8034 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8035 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8036 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8037 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8038 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8039 exists.
8040
8041 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8042 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8043 unobvious parameters.
8044
8045 Example :
8046 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8047 backend public_www
8048 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8049 stats enable
8050 stats hide-version
8051 stats scope .
8052 stats uri /admin?stats
8053 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8054 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8055 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8056
8057 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8058 backend private_monitoring
8059 stats enable
8060 stats uri /admin?stats
8061 stats refresh 5s
8062
8063 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8064
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008065
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008066stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008067 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008069 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008070
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008071 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008072 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8073
8074 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8075 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8076
8077 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8078 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008079 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008080
8081 Example :
8082 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8083 backend private_monitoring
8084 stats enable
8085 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8086 stats uri /admin?stats
8087 stats refresh 5s
8088
8089 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8090 global section.
8091
8092
8093stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008094 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8096 yes | yes | yes | yes
8097 Arguments : none
8098
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008099 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008100 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8101 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8102 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8103 - IP (socket, server)
8104 - cookie (backend, server)
8105
8106 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8107 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008108 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008109
8110 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8111
8112
8113stats show-node [ <name> ]
8114 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008116 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008117 Arguments:
8118 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8119 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8120
8121 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8122 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008123 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008124
8125 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8126 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8127 unobvious parameters.
8128
8129 Example:
8130 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8131 backend private_monitoring
8132 stats enable
8133 stats show-node Europe-1
8134 stats uri /admin?stats
8135 stats refresh 5s
8136
8137 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8138 section.
8139
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008140
8141stats uri <prefix>
8142 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008144 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008145 Arguments :
8146 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8147 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8148 query string.
8149
8150 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8151 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8152 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8153 possible to reach it in the application.
8154
8155 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008156 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008157 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8158 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8159 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8160 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8161
8162 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8163 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8164 an address or a port to statistics only.
8165
8166 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8167 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8168 unobvious parameters.
8169
8170 Example :
8171 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8172 backend public_www
8173 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8174 stats enable
8175 stats hide-version
8176 stats scope .
8177 stats uri /admin?stats
8178 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8179 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8180 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8181
8182 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8183 backend private_monitoring
8184 stats enable
8185 stats uri /admin?stats
8186 stats refresh 5s
8187
8188 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8189
8190
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008191stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8192 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008194 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008195
8196 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008197 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008198 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8199 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8200 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8201
8202 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8203 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8204 the "stick-table" statement.
8205
8206 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8207 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8208 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8209 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8210 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8211
8212 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8213 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8214 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8215 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8216 transformation rules.
8217
8218 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8219 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8220 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8221 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8222 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8223 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8224 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8225
8226 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8227 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8228 ACL based conditions.
8229
8230 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8231 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8232 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8233 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8234
8235 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8236 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8237 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8238 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8239
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008240 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8241 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8242 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8243
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008244 Example :
8245 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8246 # last 30 minutes
8247 backend pop
8248 mode tcp
8249 balance roundrobin
8250 stick store-request src
8251 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8252 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8253 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8254
8255 backend smtp
8256 mode tcp
8257 balance roundrobin
8258 stick match src table pop
8259 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8260 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8261
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008262 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008263 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008264
8265
8266stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8267 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8269 no | no | yes | yes
8270
8271 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8272 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8273 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8274 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8275
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008276 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8277 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8278 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8279
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008280 Examples :
8281 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008282 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008283
8284 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8285 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8286 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8287
8288
8289 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8290 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8291 backend http
8292 mode http
8293 balance roundrobin
8294 stick on src table https
8295 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8296 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8297 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8298
8299 backend https
8300 mode tcp
8301 balance roundrobin
8302 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8303 stick on src
8304 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8305 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8306
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008307 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008308
8309
8310stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8311 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8313 no | no | yes | yes
8314
8315 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008316 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008317 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8318 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8319 server is selected.
8320
8321 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8322 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8323 the "stick-table" statement.
8324
8325 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8326 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8327 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8328 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8329 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8330 address.
8331
8332 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8333 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8334 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8335 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8336 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8337 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8338 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8339 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8340 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8341 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8342
8343 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8344 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8345 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8346 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8347 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8348 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8349 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8350
8351 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8352 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8353 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8354 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8355
8356 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8357 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8358 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8359 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8360 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8361 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008362 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8363 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8364 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8365 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8366 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8367 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008368
8369 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8370 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8371 the request.
8372
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008373 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8374 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8375 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8376
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008377 Example :
8378 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8379 # last 30 minutes
8380 backend pop
8381 mode tcp
8382 balance roundrobin
8383 stick store-request src
8384 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8385 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8386 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8387
8388 backend smtp
8389 mode tcp
8390 balance roundrobin
8391 stick match src table pop
8392 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8393 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8394
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008395 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008396 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008397
8398
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008399stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008400 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8401 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008402 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008404 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008405
8406 Arguments :
8407 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8408 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8409 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8410 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8411
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008412 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8413 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8414 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8415 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8416
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008417 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8418 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8419 instance.
8420
8421 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8422 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8423 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8424 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8425 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8426 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008427 to 32 characters.
8428
8429 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8430 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8431 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008432 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008433 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8434 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008435
8436 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008437 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8438 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008439 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8440 increase.
8441
8442 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008443 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8444 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8445 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008446
8447 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8448 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8449 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8450 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8451 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8452 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8453 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8454 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8455 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8456 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8457 parameter (see below).
8458
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008459 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8460 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8461 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8462 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8463 soft restart.
8464
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008465 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8466 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008467
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008468 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8469 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8470 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8471 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8472 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008473 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008474 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8475 if not expiration delay is specified.
8476
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008477 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8478 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8479 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8480 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008481 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8482 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8483 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8484 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8485 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8486 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8487 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8488 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8489 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8490 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8491 types and their arguments.
8492
8493 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8494 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8495 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8496 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8497
8498 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8499 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8500 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8501 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8502
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008503 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8504 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8505 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8506 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8507 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8508 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8509
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008510 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8511 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8512 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8513 they were received.
8514
8515 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8516 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8517 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8518 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8519 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8520
8521 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8522 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8523 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8524 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8525 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8526
8527 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8528 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8529 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8530
8531 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8532 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8533 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8534 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8535 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8536
8537 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8538 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8539 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8540 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8541 the client side.
8542
8543 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8544 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8545 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8546 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8547 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8548 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8549 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8550
8551 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8552 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8553 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8554 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8555 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8556 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8557 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8558
8559 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8560 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8561 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8562 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8563 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8564 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8565
8566 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8567 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8568 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8569 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8570
8571 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8572 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8573 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8574 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8575 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8576 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8577 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8578 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8579 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8580 recommended for better fairness.
8581
8582 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8583 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8584 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8585 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8586
8587 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8588 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8589 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8590 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8591 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8592 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8593 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8594 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8595 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8596 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008597
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008598 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8599 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008600 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8601 reference it.
8602
8603 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8604 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008605 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8606 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8607 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008608
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008609 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8610 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8611 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8612 something that can be ignored.
8613
8614 Example:
8615 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8616 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8617 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8618 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8619
8620 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008621 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008622
8623
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008624stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008625 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8627 no | no | yes | yes
8628
8629 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008630 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008631 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8632 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8633 server is selected.
8634
8635 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8636 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8637 the "stick-table" statement.
8638
8639 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8640 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8641 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8642 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8643
8644 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8645 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8646 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8647 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8648 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8649 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008650 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008651 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8652 rules.
8653
8654 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8655 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8656 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8657 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8658 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8659 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8660 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8661
8662 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8663 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8664 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8665 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8666
8667 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8668 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8669 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8670 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8671 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8672 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008673 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8674 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8675 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8676 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8677 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8678 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8679 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8680 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8681 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008682
8683 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8684
8685 Example :
8686 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8687 backend https
8688 mode tcp
8689 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008690 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008691 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008692
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008693 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8694 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8695
8696 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8697 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8698 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8699
8700 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8701 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008702
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008703 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8704 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8705 # at offset 44.
8706
8707 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8708 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8709
8710 # Learn on response if server hello.
8711 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008712
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008713 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8714 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8715
8716 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8717 extraction.
8718
8719
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008720tcp-check connect [params*]
8721 Opens a new connection
8722 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8723 no | no | yes | yes
8724
8725 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8726 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8727 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8728
8729 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8730 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8731 of the sequence.
8732
8733 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8734 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8735 do.
8736
8737 Parameters :
8738 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8739 use the TCP connection.
8740
8741 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8742 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8743 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8744
8745 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8746
8747 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8748
8749 Examples:
8750 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8751 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8752 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8753 option tcp-check
8754 tcp-check connect
8755 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8756 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8757 tcp-check send \r\n
8758 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8759 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8760 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8761 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8762 tcp-check send \r\n
8763 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8764 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8765
8766 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8767 option tcp-check
8768 tcp-check connect port 110
8769 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8770 tcp-check connect port 143
8771 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8772 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8773
8774 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8775
8776
8777tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8778 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8779 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8780 no | no | yes | yes
8781
8782 Arguments :
8783 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8784 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8785 binary.
8786 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8787 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8788 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8789
8790 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8791 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8792 with the usual backslash ('\').
8793 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8794 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8795 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8796 used upper or lower case.
8797
8798
8799 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8800
8801 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8802 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8803 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8804 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8805 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8806 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8807 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8808 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8809
8810 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8811 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8812 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8813 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8814 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8815 expression.
8816
8817 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8818 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8819 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8820 this exact hexadecimal string.
8821 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8822
8823 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8824 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8825 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8826 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8827 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8828 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8829 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8830 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8831 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8832 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8833 the null character.
8834
8835 Examples :
8836 # perform a POP check
8837 option tcp-check
8838 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8839
8840 # perform an IMAP check
8841 option tcp-check
8842 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8843
8844 # look for the redis master server
8845 option tcp-check
8846 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008847 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008848 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8849 tcp-check expect string role:master
8850 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8851 tcp-check expect string +OK
8852
8853
8854 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8855 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8856
8857
8858tcp-check send <data>
8859 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8860 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8861 no | no | yes | yes
8862
8863 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8864 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8865
8866 Examples :
8867 # look for the redis master server
8868 option tcp-check
8869 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8870 tcp-check expect string role:master
8871
8872 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8873 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8874
8875
8876tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8877 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8878 tcp health check
8879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8880 no | no | yes | yes
8881
8882 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8883 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8884 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8885 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8886 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8887 hexadecimal string.
8888 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8889
8890 Examples :
8891 # redis check in binary
8892 option tcp-check
8893 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8894 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8895
8896
8897 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8898 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8899
8900
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008901tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8902 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8904 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008905 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008906 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8907 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008908
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008909 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008910
8911 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8912 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008913 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8914 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8915 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8916 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8917 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8918 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008919
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008920 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8921 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8922 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8923 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008924
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008925 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008926 - accept :
8927 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8928 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8929 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008930
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008931 - reject :
8932 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8933 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8934 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8935 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8936 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8937 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8938 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8939 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8940 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8941 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8942 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008943 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008944
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008945 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8946 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8947 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8948 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8949 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8950 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8951 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8952 hosts.
8953
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008954 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8955 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8956 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8957 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8958 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8959 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8960 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8961 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8962
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008963 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8964 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8965 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8966 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8967 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8968 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8969 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8970 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8971 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008972 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8973 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008974
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008975 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008976 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008977 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008978 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008979 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8980 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008981 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008982 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8983 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8984 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8985 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8986 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008987
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008988 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008989 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008990 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008991 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8992 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8993 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8994 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008995
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008996 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8997 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8998 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8999 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009000
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009001 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9002 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9003 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9004 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9005 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009006 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9007 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9008 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9009 layer7 information is extracted.
9010
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009011 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9012 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9013 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9014 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9015 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009016
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009017 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9018 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9019 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9020 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9021
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009022 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9023 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9024 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9025 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9026 continues.
9027
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009028 - set-src <expr> :
9029 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9030 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9031 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9032 set-src"
9033
9034 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9035 followed by some converters.
9036
9037 Example:
9038
9039 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9040
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009041 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9042 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009043
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009044 - set-src-port <expr> :
9045 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9046 expression.
9047
9048 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9049 followed by some converters.
9050
9051 Example:
9052
9053 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9054
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009055 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9056 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9057 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009058
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009059 - set-dst <expr> :
9060 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9061 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9062 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9063 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9064 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9065
9066 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9067 followed by some converters.
9068
9069 Example:
9070
9071 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9072 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9073
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009074 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9075 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9076
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009077 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9078 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9079 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9080 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9081
9082
9083 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9084 followed by some converters.
9085
9086 Example:
9087
9088 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9089
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009090 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9091 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9092 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9093
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009094 - "silent-drop" :
9095 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9096 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9097 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9098 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9099 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9100 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9101 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9102 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9103 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9104 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9105 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9106 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9107 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9108 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9109 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9110 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9111
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009112 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9113 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9114 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009115
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009116 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9117 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9118 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009119
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009120 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009121 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009122 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009123
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009124 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9125 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9126 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009127
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009128 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009129 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9130 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009131
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009132 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9133
9134 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9135
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009136 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9137
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009138 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009139
9140
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009141tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9142 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009144 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009145 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009146 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9147 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009148
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009149 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009150
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009151 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9152 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9153 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9154 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9155 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009156
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009157 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9158 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9159 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9160 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009161 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9162 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9163 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9164 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9165 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9166 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009167 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009168 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009169
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009170 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9171 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9172 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9173 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009174
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009175 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009176 - accept : the request is accepted
9177 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9178 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009179 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009180 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009181 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009182 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009183 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009184 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009185
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009186 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9187 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009188
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009189 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9190 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9191 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9192 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9193 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9194 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009195
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009196 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009197 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9198 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009199
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009200 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009201 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9202 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9203 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9204 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009205 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9206 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9207 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009208
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009209 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009210 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9211 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9212 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009213
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009214 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009215 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9216 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009217
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009218 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9219 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009220 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009221 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9222 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009223 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009224 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009225 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009226 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9227 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009228 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009229 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9230 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009231
9232 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9233 followed by some converters.
9234
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009235 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9236 <var-name>.
9237
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009238 Example:
9239
9240 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009241 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009242
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009243 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009244 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9245 # and reject everything else.
9246 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9247 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009248 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009249 tcp-request content reject
9250
9251 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009252 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9253 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9254 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009255 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009256
9257 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9258 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9259 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009260 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009261 tcp-request content reject
9262
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009263 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009264 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009265 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009266 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009267 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9268 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009269
9270 Example:
9271 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9272 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009273 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009274
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009275 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009276 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009277
9278 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009279 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009280 # protecting all our sites
9281 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009282 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9283 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009284 ...
9285 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9286
9287 backend http_dynamic
9288 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009289 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009290 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009291 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009292 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009293 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009294 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009296 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009297
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009298 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9299 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009300
9301
9302tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9303 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009305 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009306 Arguments :
9307 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9308 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9309 as explained at the top of this document.
9310
9311 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9312 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9313 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9314 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9315 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9316
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009317 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9318 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9319 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9320 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9321
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009322 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9323 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009324 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009325 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009326 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9327 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9328 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9329 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009330
9331 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9332 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9333 it pass through unaffected.
9334
9335 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9336 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9337 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009338 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009339 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9340 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009341 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9342 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9343 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009344
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009345 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009346 "timeout client".
9347
9348
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009349tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9350 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9352 no | no | yes | yes
9353 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009354 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9355 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009356
9357 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9358
9359 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9360 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9361 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009362 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9363 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009364
9365 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9366
9367 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9368 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9369 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9370 inserted.
9371
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009372 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009373 - accept :
9374 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9375 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9376 the rules evaluation.
9377
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009378 - close :
9379 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9380 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9381 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9382 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9383 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9384 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009385 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009386 protocols.
9387
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009388 - reject :
9389 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9390 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009391 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009392
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009393 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9394 Sets a variable.
9395
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009396 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9397 Unsets a variable.
9398
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009399 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9400 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9401 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9402 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9403
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009404 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9405 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9406 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9407 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9408 continues.
9409
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009410 - "silent-drop" :
9411 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9412 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9413 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9414 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9415 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9416 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9417 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9418 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9419 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9420 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9421 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9422 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9423 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9424 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9425 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9426 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9427
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009428 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9429 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9430 for changing the default action to a reject.
9431
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009432 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9433 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9434 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9435 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009436 period.
9437
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009438 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9439 declared inline.
9440
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009441 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9442 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009443 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009444 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9445 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009446 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009447 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009448 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009449 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9450 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009451 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009452 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9453 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009454
9455 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9456 followed by some converters.
9457
9458 Example:
9459
9460 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9461
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009462 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9463 <var-name>.
9464
9465 Example:
9466
9467 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9468
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009469 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9470
9471 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9472
9473
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009474tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9475 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9477 no | yes | yes | no
9478 Arguments :
9479 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9480 below.
9481
9482 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9483
9484 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9485 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9486 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9487 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9488 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9489 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9490 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9491 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9492 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9493 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9494 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9495 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9496 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9497 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9498 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9499 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9500 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9501 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9502 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9503 instead.
9504
9505 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9506 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9507 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9508 rules which may be inserted.
9509
9510 Several types of actions are supported :
9511 - accept : the request is accepted
9512 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9513 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9514 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9515 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9516 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009517 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009518 - silent-drop
9519
9520 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9521 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9522 sections for a complete description.
9523
9524 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9525 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9526 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9527
9528 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9529 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9530 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9531 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9532 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9533
9534 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9535 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9536
9537 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9538 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9539 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9540
9541 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9542 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9543 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9544
9545 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9546 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9547 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9548
9549 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9550 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9551 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9552
9553 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9554
9555 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9556
9557
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009558tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9559 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9561 no | no | yes | yes
9562 Arguments :
9563 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9564 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9565 as explained at the top of this document.
9566
9567 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9568
9569
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009570timeout check <timeout>
9571 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9572 established.
9573
9574 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9575 yes | no | yes | yes
9576 Arguments:
9577 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9578 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9579 as explained at the top of this document.
9580
9581 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9582 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9583 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9584 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009585 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9586 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9587 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009588
9589 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9590 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9591
9592 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9593 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009594 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009595
9596 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9597 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9598 forget about it.
9599
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009600 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9601 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009602
9603
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009604timeout client <timeout>
9605timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9606 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9608 yes | yes | yes | no
9609 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009610 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009611 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9612 as explained at the top of this document.
9613
9614 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9615 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9616 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009617 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9618 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9619 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9620 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009621 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9622 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9623 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009624 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009625 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009626 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9627 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009628 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9629 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009630
9631 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9632 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9633 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9634 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9635 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9636 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9637
9638 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9639 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9640 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9641
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009642 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9643 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009644
9645
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009646timeout client-fin <timeout>
9647 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9649 yes | yes | yes | no
9650 Arguments :
9651 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9652 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9653 as explained at the top of this document.
9654
9655 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9656 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9657 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9658 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9659 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9660 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9661 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9662 down in one direction.
9663
9664 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9665 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9666 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9667
9668 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9669
9670
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009671timeout connect <timeout>
9672timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9673 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9675 yes | no | yes | yes
9676 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009677 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009678 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9679 as explained at the top of this document.
9680
9681 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009682 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009683 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009684 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009685 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9686 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009687
9688 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9689 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9690 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9691 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9692 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9693 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9694
9695 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9696 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9697 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9698
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009699 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9700 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009701
9702
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009703timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9704 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9706 yes | yes | yes | yes
9707 Arguments :
9708 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9709 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9710 as explained at the top of this document.
9711
9712 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9713 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9714 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9715 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9716 once the request has started to present itself.
9717
9718 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9719 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9720 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9721 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9722 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9723
9724 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9725 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9726 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9727 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9728
9729 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9730 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9731 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9732 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9733 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009734 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009735
9736 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9737 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9738 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9739 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9740
9741 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9742
9743
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009744timeout http-request <timeout>
9745 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009747 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009748 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009749 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009750 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9751 as explained at the top of this document.
9752
9753 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9754 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9755 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9756 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9757 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9758 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9759 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009760 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9761 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9762 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9763 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9764 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009765 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9766 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009767
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009768 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9769 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9770 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9771 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9772 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009773 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009774
9775 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9776 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9777 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9778 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9779 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9780
9781 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009782 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9783 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9784 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009785
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009786 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009787 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009788
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009789
9790timeout queue <timeout>
9791 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9793 yes | no | yes | yes
9794 Arguments :
9795 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9796 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9797 as explained at the top of this document.
9798
9799 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9800 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9801 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9802 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9803 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9804
9805 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9806 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9807 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9808 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9809
9810 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9811
9812
9813timeout server <timeout>
9814timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9815 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9817 yes | no | yes | yes
9818 Arguments :
9819 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9820 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9821 as explained at the top of this document.
9822
9823 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9824 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9825 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9826 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9827 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9828 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9829 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9830
9831 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9832 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9833 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9834 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9835 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009836 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009837 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009838 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9839 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9840 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9841 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009842
9843 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9844 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9845 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9846 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9847 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9848 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9849
9850 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9851 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9852 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9853
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009854 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009855
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009856
9857timeout server-fin <timeout>
9858 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9860 yes | no | yes | yes
9861 Arguments :
9862 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9863 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9864 as explained at the top of this document.
9865
9866 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9867 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9868 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9869 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9870 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9871 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9872 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9873 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9874 situations, it should not be needed.
9875
9876 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9877 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9878 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9879
9880 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9881
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009882
9883timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009884 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9886 yes | yes | yes | yes
9887 Arguments :
9888 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9889 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9890 as explained at the top of this document.
9891
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009892 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
9893 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
9894 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
9895 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009896
9897 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9898 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9899 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9900 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009901 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009902
9903 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9904
9905
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009906timeout tunnel <timeout>
9907 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9909 yes | no | yes | yes
9910 Arguments :
9911 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9912 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9913 as explained at the top of this document.
9914
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009915 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009916 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9917 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9918 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9919 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9920 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9921 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9922 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9923 specified.
9924
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009925 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9926 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9927 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9928 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9929 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9930 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9931 state.
9932
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009933 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9934 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9935 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9936 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9937 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9938
9939 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9940 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9941 forget about it.
9942
9943 Example :
9944 defaults http
9945 option http-server-close
9946 timeout connect 5s
9947 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009948 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009949 timeout server 30s
9950 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9951
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009952 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009953
9954
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009955transparent (deprecated)
9956 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009958 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009959 Arguments : none
9960
9961 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9962 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9963 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9964 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9965 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9966 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9967 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9968 appropriate server.
9969
9970 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9971
9972 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9973 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9974
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009975 See also: "option transparent"
9976
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009977unique-id-format <string>
9978 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9980 yes | yes | yes | no
9981 Arguments :
9982 <string> is a log-format string.
9983
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009984 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9985 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9986 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9987 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009988
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009989 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9990 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9991 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9992 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9993 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9994 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9995 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9996 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009997
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009998 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9999 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010000
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010001 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010002
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010003 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010004
10005 will generate:
10006
10007 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10008
10009 See also: "unique-id-header"
10010
10011unique-id-header <name>
10012 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10014 yes | yes | yes | no
10015 Arguments :
10016 <name> is the name of the header.
10017
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010018 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10019 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010020
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010021 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010022
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010023 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010024 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10025
10026 will generate:
10027
10028 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10029
10030 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010031
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010032use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010033 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10035 no | yes | yes | no
10036 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010037 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10038 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010039
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010040 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10041 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010042
10043 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10044 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10045 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010046 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
10047 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
10048 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10049 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010050
10051 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10052 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10053 assign the backend.
10054
10055 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10056 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10057 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10058 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10059 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10060 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10061
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010062 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010063 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010064 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10065 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10066 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10067
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010068 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10069 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10070 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10071 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10072 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10073 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10074 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10075 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10076 cannot be forced from the request.
10077
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010078 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010079 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10080 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10081
10082 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10083 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010084
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010085
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010086use-server <server> if <condition>
10087use-server <server> unless <condition>
10088 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10090 no | no | yes | yes
10091 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010092 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010093
10094 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10095
10096 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10097 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10098 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10099
10100 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10101 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10102 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10103 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10104 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10105 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10106 matches will assign the server.
10107
10108 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10109 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10110 with the next rules until one matches.
10111
10112 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10113 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10114 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10115 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10116
10117 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10118 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10119 stripped.
10120
10121 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10122 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10123 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10124 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10125
10126 Example :
10127 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10128 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10129 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10130 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10131 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10132 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010133 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010134 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10135 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10136
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010137 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010138
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010139
101405. Bind and Server options
10141--------------------------
10142
10143The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10144depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10145settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10146written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10147described in this section.
10148
10149
101505.1. Bind options
10151-----------------
10152
10153The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10154as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10155no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10156parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10157while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10158provided immediately after the setting name.
10159
10160The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10161
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010162accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10163 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10164 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10165 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10166 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10167 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10168 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10169 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10170 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10171 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010172 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10173 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10174 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010175
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010176accept-proxy
10177 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010178 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10179 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010180 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10181 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10182 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10183 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10184 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10185 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10186 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010187 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10188 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010189
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010190alpn <protocols>
10191 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10192 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10193 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10194 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10195 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10196 initial NPN extension.
10197
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010198backlog <backlog>
10199 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10200 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10201
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010202curves <curves>
10203 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10204 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10205 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10206 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10207 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10208 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10209
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010210ecdhe <named curve>
10211 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010212 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10213 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010214
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010215ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010216 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10217 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10218 client's certificate.
10219
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010220ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10221 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10222 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10223 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10224 error is ignored.
10225
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010226ca-sign-file <cafile>
10227 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10228 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10229 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10230 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10231 'generate-certificates' for details.
10232
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010233ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010234 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10235 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10236 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10237 'generate-certificates' for details.
10238
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010239ciphers <ciphers>
10240 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10241 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010242 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010243 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10244 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
10245
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010246crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010247 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10248 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10249 to verify client's certificate.
10250
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010251crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010252 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10253 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10254 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10255 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10256 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10257 file.
10258
10259 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10260 are loaded.
10261
10262 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010263 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010264 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10265 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10266 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10267 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10268 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10269 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10270 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010271
10272 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10273 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10274 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10275 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010276 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10277 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010278
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010279 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010280
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010281 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10282 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010283 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010284 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10285 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10286 clients).
10287
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010288 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10289 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10290 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10291 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10292 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10293 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10294 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10295 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10296 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10297 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10298 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10299 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10300 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10301
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010302 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10303 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10304 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10305 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10306 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10307
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010308 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10309 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10310 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10311 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010312
10313 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10314 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10315 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10316 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10317 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10318 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10319 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10320 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10321 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10322
10323 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10324
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010325 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010326 a cert bundle.
10327
10328 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10329 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10330 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10331 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10332 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10333 provide multi-cert support.
10334
10335 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10336
10337 Filename | CN | SAN
10338 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10339 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010340 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010341 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10342 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10343
10344 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10345 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10346 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10347 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010348 suites. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported, no need to bundle
10349 certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010350
10351 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10352 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10353
10354 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10355 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10356 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10357
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010358crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010359 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10360 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010361 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010362 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010363
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010364crt-list <file>
10365 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010366 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10367 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010368
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010369 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10370
10371 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca_file", "crl_file", "ecdhe",
Emmanuel Hocdet4608ed92017-01-20 13:06:27 +010010372 "curves", "ciphers" configuration.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010373 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010374
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010375 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10376 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10377 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10378 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10379 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10380 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10381 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10382 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010383
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010384 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010385 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010386 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported,
10387 avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can be declared in a
10388 row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010389
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010390 crt-list file example:
10391 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010392 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010393 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010394 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010395
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010396defer-accept
10397 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10398 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10399 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10400 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10401 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10402 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10403 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10404 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10405 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10406 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10407 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10408
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010409expose-fd listeners
10410 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10411 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
10412 See alors "-x" in the management guide.
10413
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010414force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010415 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010416 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010417 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010418 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010419
10420force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010421 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010422 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010423 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010424
10425force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010426 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010427 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010428 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010429
10430force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010431 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010432 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010433 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010434
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010435force-tlsv13
10436 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10437 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010438 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010439
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010440generate-certificates
10441 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10442 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10443 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10444 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10445 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10446 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10447 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10448 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10449 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10450 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10451 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10452
10453 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10454 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10455 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10456 certificate is used many times.
10457
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010458gid <gid>
10459 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10460 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10461 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10462 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10463 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10464
10465group <group>
10466 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10467 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10468 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10469 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10470 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10471
10472id <id>
10473 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10474 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10475 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10476 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10477
10478interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010479 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10480 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10481 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10482 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10483 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10484 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10485 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010486
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010487level <level>
10488 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10489 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10490 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10491 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10492 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10493 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10494 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10495 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10496 counters).
10497 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10498 all counters).
10499
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010500maxconn <maxconn>
10501 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10502 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10503 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10504 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10505 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10506 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10507 eat all memory.
10508
10509mode <mode>
10510 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10511 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10512 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10513 UNIX sockets.
10514
10515mss <maxseg>
10516 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10517 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10518 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10519 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10520 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10521 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10522 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10523 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10524 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10525 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10526 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10527
10528name <name>
10529 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10530 page.
10531
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010532namespace <name>
10533 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10534 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10535 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10536 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10537
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010538nice <nice>
10539 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10540 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10541 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10542 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10543 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10544 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10545 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10546 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10547 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10548 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10549 one for an RDP socket.
10550
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010551no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010552 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010553 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010554 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010555 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010556 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
10557 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010558
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010559no-tls-tickets
10560 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10561 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10562 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010563 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10564 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010565
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010566no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010567 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010568 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010569 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010570 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010571 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10572 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010573
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010574no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010575 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010576 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010577 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010578 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010579 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10580 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010581
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010582no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010583 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010584 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010585 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010586 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010587 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10588 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010589
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010590no-tlsv13
10591 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10592 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
10593 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
10594 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010595 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10596 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010597
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010598npn <protocols>
10599 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10600 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10601 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10602 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010603 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10604 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010605
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000010606prefer-client-ciphers
10607 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
10608 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
10609 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
10610
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010611process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10612 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10613 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10614 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10615 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10616 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10617 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10618 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010619 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10620 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10621 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10622 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10623 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10624 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10625 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010626
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010627ssl
10628 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010629 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010630 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10631 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10632 to deciphered contents.
10633
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010634ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10635 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
10636 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10637 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
10638
10639ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10640 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
10641 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10642 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
10643
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010644strict-sni
10645 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10646 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10647 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10648 See the "crt" option for more information.
10649
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010650tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010651 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010652 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10653 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010654 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010655 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10656 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10657 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10658 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10659 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10660 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10661 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10662
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010663tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010664 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010665 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10666 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10667 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10668 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10669 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10670 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10671 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010672 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10673 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10674 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010675
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010676tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10677 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10678 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10679 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10680 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10681 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10682 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10683 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10684 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10685 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10686 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10687
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010688transparent
10689 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10690 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10691 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10692 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10693 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10694 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10695 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10696 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10697 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10698 so check for support with your vendor.
10699
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010700v4v6
10701 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10702 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10703 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10704 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010705 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010706
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010707v6only
10708 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10709 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10710 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010711 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10712 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010713
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010714uid <uid>
10715 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10716 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10717 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10718 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10719 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10720
10721user <user>
10722 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10723 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10724 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10725 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10726 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10727
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010728verify [none|optional|required]
10729 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10730 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10731 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10732 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10733 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010734 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10735 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10736 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10737 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010738
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200107395.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010740------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010741
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010742The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10743which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10744arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10745settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10746after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10747Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10748address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010749
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010750 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010751 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010752
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010753Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
10754keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
10755
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010756The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010757
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010758addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010759 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010760 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10761 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10762 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10763 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10764 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010765
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010766agent-check
10767 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010768 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10769 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10770 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10771 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010772
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010773 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010774 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010775 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10776 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10777 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010778
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010779 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10780 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10781 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10782 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10783 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10784
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010785 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10786 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010787
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010788 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10789 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10790 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010791
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010792 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10793 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10794 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010795
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010796 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10797 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10798 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10799 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10800 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10801 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10802 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010803
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010804 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10805 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010806
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010807 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10808 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10809 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10810 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10811 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10812 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10813 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10814 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10815 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010816
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010817 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10818 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010819 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10820 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10821 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010822 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010823
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010824 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010825 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010826
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010827agent-send <string>
10828 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10829 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10830 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10831 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10832 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10833
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010834agent-inter <delay>
10835 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10836 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10837
10838 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10839 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10840 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10841 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10842 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10843 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10844 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10845 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10846 of backends use the same servers.
10847
10848 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10849
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010010850agent-addr <addr>
10851 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
10852
10853 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
10854 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
10855 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
10856 hostname, it will be resolved.
10857
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010858agent-port <port>
10859 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10860
10861 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10862
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010863backup
10864 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10865 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10866 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10867 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010868 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
10869 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010870
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010871ca-file <cafile>
10872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10873 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10874 server's certificate.
10875
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010876check
10877 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010878 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10879 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10880 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10881 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10882 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10883 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10884 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010885 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10886 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010887 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
10888 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010889
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010890check-send-proxy
10891 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10892 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10893 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10894 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10895 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10896 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10897 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10898
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010899check-ssl
10900 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10901 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10902 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10903 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010904 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010905 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10906 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10907 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010908 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
10909 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010910
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010911ciphers <ciphers>
10912 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010913 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010914 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10915 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10916 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10917 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10918 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10919 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10920
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010921cookie <value>
10922 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10923 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10924 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10925 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10926 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10927 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10928 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10929
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010930crl-file <crlfile>
10931 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10932 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10933 to verify server's certificate.
10934
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010935crt <cert>
10936 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10937 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10938 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10939 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10940 certificate request.
10941
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010942disabled
10943 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10944 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10945 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10946 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10947 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010948 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010949
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010950enabled
10951 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
10952 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
10953 default value.
10954 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
10955 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010957error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010958 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10959 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10960 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010961
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010962 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010963
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010964fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010965 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10966 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10967 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10968
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010969force-sslv3
10970 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10971 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010972 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010973 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010974
10975force-tlsv10
10976 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010977 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010978 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010979
10980force-tlsv11
10981 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010982 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010983 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010984
10985force-tlsv12
10986 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010987 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010988 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010989
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010990force-tlsv13
10991 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10992 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010993 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010994
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010995id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010996 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10997 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10998 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010999
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011000init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11001 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11002 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
11003 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
11004 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11005 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11006 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11007 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11008 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11009 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11010 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11011 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11012 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
11013 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
11014 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11015 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11016 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11017 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11018 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11019 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
11020 historic behaviour.
11021
11022 Example:
11023 defaults
11024 # never fail on address resolution
11025 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11026
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011027inter <delay>
11028fastinter <delay>
11029downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011030 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11031 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11032 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11033 between checks depending on the server state :
11034
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011035 Server state | Interval used
11036 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11037 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11038 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11039 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11040 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11041 or yet unchecked. |
11042 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11043 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11044 | "inter" otherwise.
11045 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011046
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011047 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11048 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11049 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11050 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011051 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11052 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11053 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11054 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11055 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011057maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011058 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11059 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11060 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11061 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11062 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11063 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11064 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11065 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11066
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011067maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011068 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11069 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11070 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11071 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11072 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11073 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11074 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11075
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011076minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011077 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11078 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11079 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11080 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11081 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11082 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011083 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011084 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011085
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011086namespace <name>
11087 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11088 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11089 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11090 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11091
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011092no-agent-check
11093 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11094 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11095 default value.
11096 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11097 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11098
11099no-backup
11100 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11101 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11102 default value.
11103 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11104 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11105
11106no-check
11107 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11108 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11109 default value.
11110 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11111 "default-server" "check" setting.
11112
11113no-check-ssl
11114 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11115 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11116 default value.
11117 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11118 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11119
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011120no-send-proxy
11121 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11122 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11123 default value.
11124 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11125 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11126
11127no-send-proxy-v2
11128 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11129 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11130 default value.
11131 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11132 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11133
11134no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11135 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11136 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11137 default value.
11138 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11139 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11140
11141no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11142 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11143 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11144 default value.
11145 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11146 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11147
11148no-ssl
11149 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11150 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11151 default value.
11152 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11153 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11154
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011155no-ssl-reuse
11156 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11157 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11158 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11159 and for paranoid users.
11160
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011161no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011162 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11163 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011164 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011165
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011166 Supported in default-server: No
11167
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011168no-tls-tickets
11169 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11170 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11171 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011172 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11173 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011174 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011175
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011176no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011177 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011178 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11179 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011180 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11181 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011182 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011183
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011184 Supported in default-server: No
11185
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011186no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011187 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011188 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11189 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011190 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11191 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011192 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011193
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011194 Supported in default-server: No
11195
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011196no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011197 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011198 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11199 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011200 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11201 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011202 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011203
11204 Supported in default-server: No
11205
11206no-tlsv13
11207 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11208 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11209 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11210 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11211 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011212 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011213
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011214 Supported in default-server: No
11215
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011216no-verifyhost
11217 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11218 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11219 default value.
11220 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11221 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011222
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011223non-stick
11224 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11225 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11226 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11227
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011228observe <mode>
11229 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11230 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11231 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11232 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11233 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11234 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011235 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011236
11237 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11238
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011239on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011240 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11241 Currently, four modes are available:
11242 - fastinter: force fastinter
11243 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11244 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11245 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11246 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11247
11248 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11249
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011250on-marked-down <action>
11251 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11252 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011253 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11254 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11255 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11256 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11257 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11258 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11259 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11260 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011261
11262 Actions are disabled by default
11263
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011264on-marked-up <action>
11265 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11266 Currently one action is available:
11267 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11268 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11269 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11270 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11271 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11272 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11273 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11274 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11275
11276 Actions are disabled by default
11277
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011278port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011279 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11280 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11281 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11282 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11283 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11284 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11285
11286redir <prefix>
11287 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11288 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11289 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11290 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11291 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11292 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11293 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11294 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011295 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011296 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11297 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11298 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11299 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11300 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11301
11302 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11303
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011304rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011305 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11306 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11307 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11308
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011309resolve-prefer <family>
11310 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11311 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11312 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11313 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11314
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011315 Default value: ipv6
11316
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011317 Example:
11318
11319 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011320
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011321resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11322 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11323 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011324 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011325 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11326 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11327 configured network, another address is selected.
11328
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011329 Example:
11330
11331 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011332
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011333resolvers <id>
11334 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11335 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011336 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
11337 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
11338 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
11339 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011340
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011341 Example:
11342
11343 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011344
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011345 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011346
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011347send-proxy
11348 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11349 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11350 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11351 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011352 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11353 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11354 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11355 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11356 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11357 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11358 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11359 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11360 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11361 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011362 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11363 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011364
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011365send-proxy-v2
11366 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11367 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11368 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11369 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11370 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011371 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the
11372 "no-send-proxy-v2" option of this section and send-proxy" option of the
11373 "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011374
11375send-proxy-v2-ssl
11376 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11377 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11378 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11379 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11380 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11381 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11382 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011383 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11384 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011385
11386send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11387 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11388 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11389 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11390 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11391 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11392 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11393 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11394 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011395 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and the
11396 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011397
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011398slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011399 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11400 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11401 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11402 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11403 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11404 parameters :
11405
11406 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11407 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11408
11409 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11410 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11411 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11412 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11413
11414 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11415 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11416 seen as failed.
11417
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011418sni <expression>
11419 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11420 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11421 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11422 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
11423 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
11424
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011425source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011426source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011427source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011428 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11429 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11430 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11431 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11432
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011433 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11434 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11435 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11436 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11437 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11438 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11439 server.
11440
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011441 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11442 specifying the source address without port(s).
11443
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011444ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011445 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11446 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11447 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11448 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11449 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11450 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011451 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11452 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011453
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011454ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11455 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
11456 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11457 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11458
11459ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11460 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
11461 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11462 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11463
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011464ssl-reuse
11465 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11466 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11467 default value.
11468 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11469 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11470
11471stick
11472 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11473 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11474 default value.
11475 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11476 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011477
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011478tcp-ut <delay>
11479 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11480 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11481 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011482 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011483 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11484 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11485 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11486 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11487 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11488 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11489 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11490 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11491 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11492
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011493track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011494 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11495 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11496 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11497 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011498 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11499
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011500tls-tickets
11501 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11502 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11503 default value.
11504 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11505 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011506
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011507verify [none|required]
11508 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011509 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
11510 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
11511 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
11512 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011513 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
11514 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
11515 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011516
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011517verifyhost <hostname>
11518 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
11519 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
11520 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
11521 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
11522 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
11523 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011524 See also "no-verifyhost" option.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011525
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011526weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011527 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11528 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11529 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011530 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11531 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11532 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11533 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11534 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11535 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011536
11537
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200115385.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11539-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011540
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011541HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11542using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11543configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011544This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11545can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11546workload.
11547This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11548resolution at run time.
11549Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11550carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11551
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011552Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11553health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11554
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011555
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200115565.3.1. Global overview
11557----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011558
11559As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11560different steps of the process life:
11561
11562 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11563 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11564 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11565
11566 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11567 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11568 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11569
11570A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11571 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11572 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11573 resolution to know this new IP.
11574
11575A few things important to notice:
11576 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11577 first valid response.
11578
11579 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11580 servers return an error.
11581
11582
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200115835.3.2. The resolvers section
11584----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011585
11586This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11587HAProxy.
11588There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11589many name servers.
11590
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011591When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11592uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11593is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11594answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11595
11596When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11597used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11598
11599Two types of behavior can be applied:
11600 1. stop DNS resolution
11601 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11602 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11603 1. ANY query type
11604 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11605 server's parameter
11606 3. remaining family type
11607
11608HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11609 - invalid DNS response packet
11610 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11611 - NX domain
11612 - Query refused by server
11613 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11614
11615HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11616 - no Answer records in the response
11617 - DNS response truncated
11618 - Error in DNS response
11619 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11620 - name server timeout
11621
11622For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11623 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11624 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11625 applied;
11626 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11627 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11628 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11629 stops resolution.
11630
11631
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011632resolvers <resolvers id>
11633 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11634
11635A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11636
11637nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11638 DNS server description:
11639 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11640 <ip> : IP address of the server
11641 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11642
11643hold <status> <period>
11644 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11645 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011646 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
11647 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011648 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11649 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11650 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11651
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011652 Default value is 10s for "valid" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011653
11654 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11655 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11656 the healch check.
11657
11658resolve_retries <nb>
11659 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11660 giving up.
11661 Default value: 3
11662
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011663 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11664 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11665 type.
11666
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011667timeout <event> <time>
11668 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11669 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11670 events available are:
11671 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11672 been received.
11673 Default value: 1s
11674 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11675 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11676
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011677 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011678
11679 resolvers mydns
11680 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11681 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11682 resolve_retries 3
11683 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011684 hold other 30s
11685 hold refused 30s
11686 hold nx 30s
11687 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011688 hold valid 10s
11689
11690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116916. HTTP header manipulation
11692---------------------------
11693
11694In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11695response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11696request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11697which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011698against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011699
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011700If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11701to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11702but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11703HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11704stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11705because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11706a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11707still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011708
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011709This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11710in section 4.2 :
11711
11712 - reqadd <string>
11713 - reqallow <search>
11714 - reqiallow <search>
11715 - reqdel <search>
11716 - reqidel <search>
11717 - reqdeny <search>
11718 - reqideny <search>
11719 - reqpass <search>
11720 - reqipass <search>
11721 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11722 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11723 - reqtarpit <search>
11724 - reqitarpit <search>
11725 - rspadd <string>
11726 - rspdel <search>
11727 - rspidel <search>
11728 - rspdeny <search>
11729 - rspideny <search>
11730 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11731 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11732
11733With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11734is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11735parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11736prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11737Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11738
11739 \t for a tab
11740 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11741 \n for a new line (LF)
11742 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11743 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11744 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11745 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11746 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11747
11748The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11749portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11750above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11751regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
117529 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11753is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11754
11755The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11756after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11757
11758Notes related to these keywords :
11759---------------------------------
11760 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11761 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11762 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11763
11764 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11765 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11766 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11767
11768 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11769 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11770 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11771 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11772 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11773
11774 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11775 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11776 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11777 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11778 useless headers before adding new ones.
11779
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011780 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011781 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11782
11783 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11784 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11785 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11786
11787 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11788 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011789 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011790
11791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200117927. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11793----------------------------------
11794
11795Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11796client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11797The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11798these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11799but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11800data called patterns.
11801
11802
118037.1. ACL basics
11804---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011805
11806The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11807content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11808from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11809simple :
11810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011811 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011812 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011813 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11814 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011816The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11817adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011818
11819In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011821 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011822
11823This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11824Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11825and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011826an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11827conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11828as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11829are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011830
11831ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11832'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11833which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11834
11835There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11836performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011838The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11839specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11840this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011841methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11842ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011843
11844Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11845 - boolean
11846 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11847 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11848 - string
11849 - data block
11850
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011851Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11852converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11853would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11854The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11855which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11856
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011857Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11858keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11859fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11860which are summarized in the table below :
11861
11862 +---------------------+-----------------+
11863 | Sample or converter | Default |
11864 | output type | matching method |
11865 +---------------------+-----------------+
11866 | boolean | bool |
11867 +---------------------+-----------------+
11868 | integer | int |
11869 +---------------------+-----------------+
11870 | ip | ip |
11871 +---------------------+-----------------+
11872 | string | str |
11873 +---------------------+-----------------+
11874 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11875 +---------------------+-----------------+
11876
11877Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11878matching method, see below.
11879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011880The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11881 - boolean
11882 - integer or integer range
11883 - IP address / network
11884 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11885 - regular expression
11886 - hex block
11887
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011888The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11889
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011890 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11891 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011892 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011893 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011894 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011895 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011896 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011898The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11899read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11900if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11901lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11902will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11903beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11904a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11905lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11906exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11907
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011908The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11909parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11910ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11911a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11912check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11913
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011914The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11915socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11916file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011918Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11919loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11920
11921 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11922
11923In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11924the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11925case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11926as well.
11927
11928The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11929sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11930do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11931methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11932is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11933obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11934followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11935default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11936that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11937string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11938
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011939The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11940By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11941string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11942resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11943server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11944waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11945flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11946function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011948There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11949sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11950be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011951
11952 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11953 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011954 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11955 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11956 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11957 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011958
11959 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11960 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011961 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011962
11963 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011964 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011965
11966 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011967 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011968
11969 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11970 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11971
11972 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11973 binary or string samples.
11974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011975 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11976 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011978 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11979 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11980 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011982 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11983 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011985 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11986 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011988 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11989 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011991 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11992 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011993 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011995 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11996 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11997 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011998
11999For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12000request, it is possible to do :
12001
12002 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12003
12004In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12005buffer, one would use the following acl :
12006
12007 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12008
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012009On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12010possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12011
12012 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012014All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12015criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12016method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12017to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12018criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12019the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012021If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012022the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12023For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012025 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12026 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12027 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12028 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012029
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012030
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012031The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12032types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12033combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12034brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12035default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012037 +-------------------------------------------------+
12038 | Input sample type |
12039 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012040 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012041 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12042 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12043 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012044 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012045 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012046 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012047 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012048 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012049 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012050 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012051 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012052 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012053 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012054 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012055 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012056 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012057 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012058 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012059 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012060 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012061 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012062 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012063 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012064 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012065 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12066 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12067 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012068
12069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120707.1.1. Matching booleans
12071------------------------
12072
12073In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12074Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12075When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12076that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12077
12078Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12079return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12080"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12081
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120837.1.2. Matching integers
12084------------------------
12085
12086Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12087enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12088to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12089
12090Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12091matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12092lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012093
12094For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12095unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12096representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12097
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012098As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12099two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12100instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12101ranges and operators.
12102
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012103For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012104operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12105Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12106of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012107
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012108Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012109
12110 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12111 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12112 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12113 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12114 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012116For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012117
12118 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12119
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012120This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12121
12122 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12123
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121257.1.3. Matching strings
12126-----------------------
12127
12128String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12129different forms :
12130
12131 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
12132 patterns ;
12133
12134 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
12135 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
12136
12137 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12138 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12139
12140 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12141 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12142
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012143 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012144 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12145 matches.
12146
12147 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12148 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12149 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012150
12151String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12152exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12153characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12154string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12155to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012156before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012157
12158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121597.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12160---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012161
12162Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12163they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12164possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12165passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12166the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012167the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12168match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012169
12170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121717.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12172-------------------------------------
12173
12174It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12175not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12176a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12177to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12178digits may be used upper or lower case.
12179
12180Example :
12181 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12182 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12183
12184
121857.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12186---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012187
12188IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12189netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12190within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012191host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012192difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12193at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12194does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12195parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012196
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012197The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12198abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12199
12200 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12201 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12202 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12203 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12204 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12205 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12206 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12207 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12208
12209Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12210192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12211
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012212IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12213Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12214trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12215IPv6 patterns.
12216
12217HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12218following situations :
12219 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12220 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12221 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12222 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12223 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12224 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12225 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12226 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12227 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12228 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012230
122317.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12232----------------------------------
12233
12234Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12235combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12236
12237 - AND (implicit)
12238 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12239 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012240
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012241A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012243 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012245Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12246indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012248For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12249"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12250requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12251is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12252
12253 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012254 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12255 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12256 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012257
12258To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12259and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12260
12261 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12262 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12263 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12264 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12265
12266 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12267 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12268 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12269 use_backend www if host_www
12270
12271It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12272expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12273be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12274the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12275
12276 The following rule :
12277
12278 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012279 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012280
12281 Can also be written that way :
12282
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012283 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012284
12285It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12286to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12287simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12288sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12289good use is the following :
12290
12291 With named ACLs :
12292
12293 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12294 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12295 monitor fail if site_dead
12296
12297 With anonymous ACLs :
12298
12299 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12300
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012301See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12302keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012303
12304
123057.3. Fetching samples
12306---------------------
12307
12308Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12309against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12310sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12311ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12312of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12313available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12314
12315This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12316Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12317compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12318deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12319
12320The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12321matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12322method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12323indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12324
12325As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12326when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12327mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12328the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12329ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12330
12331Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12332multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12333when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12334incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12335are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12336is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12337all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12338
12339Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12340 - name
12341 - name(arg1)
12342 - name(arg1,arg2)
12343
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012344
123457.3.1. Converters
12346-----------------
12347
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012348Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12349of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12350is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12351was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12352has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12353unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12354
12355These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12356sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12357the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12358support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012359
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012360A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12361support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12362supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12363(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12364bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012366The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012367
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001236851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12369 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12370 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12371 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12372 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12373 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12374
12375 Example :
12376 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12377 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12378 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12379 frontend http-in
12380 bind *:8081
12381 default_backend servers
12382 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12383 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12384
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012385add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012386 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012387 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012388 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12389 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012390 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012391 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12392 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12393 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12394 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12395 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012396 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012397
12398and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012399 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012400 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012401 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12402 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012403 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012404 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12405 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12406 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12407 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12408 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012409 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012410
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020012411b64dec
12412 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
12413 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
12414
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012415base64
12416 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12417 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12418 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12419
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012420bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012421 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012422 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12423 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12424 presence of a flag).
12425
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012426bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12427 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12428 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012429 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012430
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012431cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012432 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12433 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012434
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012435crc32([<avalanche>])
12436 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12437 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12438 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12439 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12440 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12441 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12442 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12443 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12444 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12445 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12446 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12447
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012448da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012449 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12450 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12451 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12452 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012453 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012454 configuration language.
12455
12456 Example:
12457 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012458 bind *:8881
12459 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012460 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012461
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012462debug
12463 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12464 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12465 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12466
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012467div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012468 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12469 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012470 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012471 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12472 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012473 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012474 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12475 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12476 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12477 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12478 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012479 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012480
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012481djb2([<avalanche>])
12482 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12483 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12484 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12485 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12486 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12487 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12488 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012489 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12490 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012491
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012492even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012493 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012494 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12495
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012496field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12497 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12498 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12499 list of chars.
12500
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012501hex
12502 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12503 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12504 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12505 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012506
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012507http_date([<offset>])
12508 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12509 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12510 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12511 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12512 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12513 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012514
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012515in_table(<table>)
12516 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12517 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12518 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12519 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12520 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12521
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012522ipmask(<mask>)
12523 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12524 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12525 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12526 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12527
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012528json([<input-code>])
12529 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12530 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012531 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012532 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12533 of errors:
12534 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12535 bytes, ...)
12536 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12537 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12538
12539 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12540 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12541 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12542 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12543 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12544 are :
12545 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12546 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12547 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12548 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12549 error ;
12550 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12551 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12552
12553 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12554 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12555
12556 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012557 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012558 capture request header user-agent len 150
12559 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012560
12561 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12562 GET / HTTP/1.0
12563 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12564
12565 Output log:
12566 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12567
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012568language(<value>[,<default>])
12569 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12570 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12571 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12572 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12573 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12574 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12575 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12576 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12577 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12578 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12579 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12580 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012581
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012582 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012583
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012584 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12585 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012586
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012587 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12588 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12589 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12590 use_backend spanish if es
12591 use_backend french if fr
12592 use_backend english if en
12593 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012594
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012595lower
12596 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12597 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12598 type. The result is of type string.
12599
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012600ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12601 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12602 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12603 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12604 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12605 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12606 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12607
12608 Example :
12609
12610 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12611 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12612 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12613
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012614map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12615map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12616map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12617 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12618 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12619 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12620 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12621 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12622 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12623 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12624 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012625
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012626 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12627 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12628 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012629
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012630 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012631 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012632
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012633 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12634 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12635 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12636 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012637 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12638 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012639 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12640 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12641 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12642 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12643 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12644 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12645 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12646 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012647 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12648 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12649 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012650 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12651 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12652 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12653 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12654 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012655
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012656 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12657 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12658 the corresponding match text.
12659
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012660 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12661 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12662 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12663 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12664 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012665
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012666 Example :
12667
12668 # this is a comment and is ignored
12669 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12670 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12671 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12672 | | | `---------- value
12673 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12674 | `---------------------------- key
12675 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12676
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012677mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012678 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12679 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012680 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012681 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012682 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012683 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12684 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12685 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12686 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12687 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012688 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012689
12690mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012691 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012692 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12693 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012694 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012695 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012696 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012697 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12698 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12699 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12700 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12701 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012702 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012703
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010012704nbsrv
12705 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
12706 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
12707 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
12708 map lookup.
12709
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012710neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012711 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12712 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12713 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12714 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012715
12716not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012717 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012718 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12719 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12720 absence of a flag).
12721
12722odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012723 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012724 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12725
12726or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012727 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012728 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012729 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12730 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012731 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012732 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12733 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12734 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12735 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12736 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012737 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012738
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012739regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012740 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12741 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12742 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12743 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12744 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12745 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12746 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12747 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12748 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12749 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012750 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12751 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12752 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12753 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012754
12755 Example :
12756
12757 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12758 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12759 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12760 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12761
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012762capture-req(<id>)
12763 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12764 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12765
12766 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012767 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12768 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012769
12770capture-res(<id>)
12771 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12772 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12773
12774 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012775 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12776 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012777
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012778sdbm([<avalanche>])
12779 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12780 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12781 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12782 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12783 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12784 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12785 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012786 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12787 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012788
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012789set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012790 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12791 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12792 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012793 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012794 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12795 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012796 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012797 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12798 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012799 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012800 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012801
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012802sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012803 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12804 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012805 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012806 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12807 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012808 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012809 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12810 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012811 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012812 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12813 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012814 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012815 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012816
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012817table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12818 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12819 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12820 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12821 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12822 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12823 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12824
12825
12826table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12827 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12828 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12829 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12830 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12831 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12832 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12833
12834table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12835 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12836 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12837 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12838 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12839 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12840
12841table_conn_cur(<table>)
12842 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12843 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12844 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12845 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12846 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12847
12848table_conn_rate(<table>)
12849 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12850 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12851 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12852 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12853 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12854
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012855table_gpt0(<table>)
12856 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12857 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12858 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12859 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12860 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12861
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012862table_gpc0(<table>)
12863 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12864 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12865 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12866 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12867 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12868
12869table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12870 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12871 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12872 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12873 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12874 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12875 sample fetch keyword.
12876
12877table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12878 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12879 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12880 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12881 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12882 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12883
12884table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12885 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12886 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12887 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12888 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12889 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12890 keyword.
12891
12892table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12893 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12894 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12895 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12896 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12897 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12898
12899table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12900 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12901 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12902 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12903 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12904 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12905 keyword.
12906
12907table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12908 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12909 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12910 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12911 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12912 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12913 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12914 keyword.
12915
12916table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12917 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12918 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12919 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12920 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12921 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12922 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12923 keyword.
12924
12925table_server_id(<table>)
12926 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12927 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12928 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12929 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12930 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12931 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12932
12933table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12934 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12935 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12936 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12937 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12938 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12939 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12940 keyword.
12941
12942table_sess_rate(<table>)
12943 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12944 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12945 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12946 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12947 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12948 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12949 keyword.
12950
12951table_trackers(<table>)
12952 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12953 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12954 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12955 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12956 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12957 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12958 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12959 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12960 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12961 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12962
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012963upper
12964 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12965 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12966 type. The result is of type string.
12967
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012968url_dec
12969 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12970 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12971
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012972unset-var(<var name>)
12973 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
12974 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12975 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
12976 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12977 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
12978 response),
12979 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12980 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
12981 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12982 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
12983
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012984utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12985 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12986 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12987 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12988 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12989 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12990 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12991
12992 Example :
12993
12994 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12995 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12996 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12997
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012998word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12999 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
13000 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13001
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013002wt6([<avalanche>])
13003 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13004 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13005 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13006 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13007 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13008 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13009 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013010 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
13011 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013012
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013013xor(<value>)
13014 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013015 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013016 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013017 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013018 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013019 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13020 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013021 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013022 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13023 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013024 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013025 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013026
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013027xxh32([<seed>])
13028 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13029 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13030 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13031 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13032 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13033 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13034 as cryptographically secure.
13035
13036xxh64([<seed>])
13037 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13038 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13039 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13040 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13041 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13042 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13043 as cryptographically secure.
13044
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013045
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200130467.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013047--------------------------------------------
13048
13049A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13050not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13051"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13052The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13053
13054always_false : boolean
13055 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13056 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13057
13058always_true : boolean
13059 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13060 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13061
13062avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013063 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013064 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13065 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13066 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13067 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13068 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13069 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13070 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13071 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13072 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13073 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13074 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13075 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13076 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013078be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013079 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13080 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13081 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13082 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
13083 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013085be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13086 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13087 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13088 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
13089 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
13090 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13091 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013092
13093 Example :
13094 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13095 backend dynamic
13096 mode http
13097 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13098 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013099
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013100bin(<hexa>) : bin
13101 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13102 of the string.
13103
13104bool(<bool>) : bool
13105 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13106 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013108connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13109 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013110 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013111 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13112 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013113
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013114 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013115 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013116 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13117
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013118 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13119 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013120
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013121 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013122 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013123 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013124 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
13125 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013126 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013127 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013128
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013129 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13130 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013131 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013132 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013133
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013134date([<offset>]) : integer
13135 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13136 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13137 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13138 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013139 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13140
13141 Example :
13142
13143 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13144 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013145
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013146env(<name>) : string
13147 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13148 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13149 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13150 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13151 certain way.
13152
13153 Examples :
13154 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13155 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13156
13157 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13158 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013160fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13161 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013162 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13163 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013164 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13165 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
13166 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
13167 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13168 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013169
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013170fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13171 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13172 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13173 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013175fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13176 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13177 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13178 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13179 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13180 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13181 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13182 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13183 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013184
13185 Example :
13186 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13187 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13188 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13189 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13190 frontend mail
13191 bind :25
13192 mode tcp
13193 maxconn 100
13194 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13195 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13196 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13197 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013198
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013199hostname : string
13200 Returns the system hostname.
13201
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013202int(<integer>) : signed integer
13203 Returns a signed integer.
13204
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013205ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13206 Returns an ipv4.
13207
13208ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13209 Returns an ipv6.
13210
13211meth(<method>) : method
13212 Returns a method.
13213
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013214nbproc : integer
13215 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13216 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13217 and debugging purposes.
13218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013219nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13220 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13221 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13222 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013223 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13224 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13225 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013226
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013227proc : integer
13228 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13229 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13230 debugging purposes.
13231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013232queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013233 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13234 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13235 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013236 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13237 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13238 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13239 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13240 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13241
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013242rand([<range>]) : integer
13243 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13244 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13245 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13246 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13247 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013249srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13250 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13251 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13252 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13253 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13254 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13255 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13256 methods.
13257
13258srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13259 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13260 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13261 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13262 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13263 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13264 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13265 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13266
13267srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13268 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13269 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013270 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013271 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13272 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13273 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13274 overloading servers).
13275
13276 Example :
13277 # Redirect to a separate back
13278 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13279 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13280 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13281
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013282stopping : boolean
13283 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13284 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13285 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13286
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013287str(<string>) : string
13288 Returns a string.
13289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013290table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13291 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13292 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13293
13294table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13295 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13296 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13297 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13298
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013299var(<var-name>) : undefined
13300 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013301 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13302 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013303 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013304 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13305 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013306 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013307 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13308 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013309 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013310 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013311
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200133127.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013313----------------------------------
13314
13315The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13316closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13317methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13318sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13319TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013320the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13321counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13322"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013323argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13324the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13325this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013326
13327be_id : integer
13328 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13329 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13330
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013331be_name : string
13332 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13333 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013335dst : ip
13336 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13337 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13338 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13339 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13340 RFC 4291.
13341
13342dst_conn : integer
13343 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13344 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13345 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13346 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13347 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13348 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13349 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13350 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013351
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013352dst_is_local : boolean
13353 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13354 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13355 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13356 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13357 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13358 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13359 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13360 it only once per connection.
13361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013362dst_port : integer
13363 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13364 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13365 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13366 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13367 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13368 an HTTP header.
13369
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013370fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13371 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13372 header.
13373
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013374fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13375 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13376 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13377 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13378 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13379 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13380 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13381
13382fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13383 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13384 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13385 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13386 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13387 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13388 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13389
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013390fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13391 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13392 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13393 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13394 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13395
13396fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13397 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13398 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13399 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13400 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13401
13402fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13403 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13404 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13405 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13406 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13407
13408fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13409 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13410 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13411 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13412 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13413
13414fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13415 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13416 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13417 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13418 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13419
13420fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13421 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13422 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13423 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13424 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013426fe_id : integer
13427 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013428 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013429 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13430
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013431fe_name : string
13432 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13433 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13434 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13435
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013436sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013437sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13438sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13439sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013440 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13441 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13442 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13443
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013444sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013445sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13446sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13447sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013448 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13449 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13450 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13451
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013452sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013453sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13454sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13455sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013456 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13457 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013458 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13459 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13460 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013461
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013462 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013463 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13464 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013465 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13466 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13467 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013468 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13469 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13470
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013471sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013472sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13473sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13474sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013475 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13476 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13477
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013478sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013479sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13480sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13481sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013482 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13483 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13484 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13485
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013486sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013487sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13488sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13489sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013490 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13491 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13492 See also src_conn_rate.
13493
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013494sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013495sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13496sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13497sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013498 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013499 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013500
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013501sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13502sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13503sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13504sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13505 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13506 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13507
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013508sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013509sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13510sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13511sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013512 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13513 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13514 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013515 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13516 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13517 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013518
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013519sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013520sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13521sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13522sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013523 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13524 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13525 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13526
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013527sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013528sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13529sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13530sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013531 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13532 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13533 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13534 src_http_err_rate.
13535
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013536sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013537sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13538sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13539sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013540 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13541 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13542 src_http_req_cnt.
13543
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013544sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013545sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13546sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13547sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013548 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13549 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13550 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13551 src_http_req_rate.
13552
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013553sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013554sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13555sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13556sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013557 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013558 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13559 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13560 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13561 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013562
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013563 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013564 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13565 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013566 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13567
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013568sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013569sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13570sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13571sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013572 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13573 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13574 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013575
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013576sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013577sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13578sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13579sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013580 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13581 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13582 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013583
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013584sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013585sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13586sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13587sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013588 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13589 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13590 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13591 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013592 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013593 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13594
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013595sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013596sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13597sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13598sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013599 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13600 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13601 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13602 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13603 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013604 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013605
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013606sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013607sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13608sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13609sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013610 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13611 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13612 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13613
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013614sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013615sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13616sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13617sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013618 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13619 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013620 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013621 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13622 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013623 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13624 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13625 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013626
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013627so_id : integer
13628 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13629 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13630 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013632src : ip
13633 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13634 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13635 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13636 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013637 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13638 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13639 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13640 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013641
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013642 Example:
13643 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13644 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013646src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13647 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13648 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13649 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013650 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013652src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13653 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13654 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013655 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013656 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013658src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13659 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13660 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13661 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13662 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13663 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13664 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013665
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013666 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013667 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13668 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13669 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13670 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013671 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013672 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13673 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013675src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013676 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013677 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013678 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013679 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013681src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013682 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013683 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13684 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013685 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013687src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13688 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13689 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13690 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013691 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013693src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013694 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013695 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013696 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013697 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013698
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013699src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13700 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13701 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13702 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13703 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013705src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013706 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013707 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013708 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13709 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013710 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13711 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13712 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013714src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13715 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13716 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013717 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013718 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013719 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013721src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13722 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13723 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13724 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13725 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013726 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013728src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13729 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13730 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13731 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013732 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013734src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13735 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13736 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13737 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013738 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013739 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013741src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13742 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13743 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13744 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013745 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013746 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13747 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013748
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013749 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013750 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013751 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013752 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013753
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013754src_is_local : boolean
13755 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13756 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13757 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13758 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13759 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13760 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13761 once per connection.
13762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013763src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013764 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13765 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13766 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13767 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13768 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013770src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013771 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13772 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13773 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13774 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13775 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013777src_port : integer
13778 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13779 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13780 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13781 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013783src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13784 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013785 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13786 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13787 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013788 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013790src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13791 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13792 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13793 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13794 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013795 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013797src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13798 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13799 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13800 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13801 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13802 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13803 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13804 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13805 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013806
13807 Example :
13808 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13809 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13810 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13811 listen ssh
13812 bind :22
13813 mode tcp
13814 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013815 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013816 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013817 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013819srv_id : integer
13820 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13821 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13822 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013823
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200138247.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013825----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013827The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13828closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13829when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13830usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013831future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013832
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001383351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
13834 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13835 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13836 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
13837 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13838 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13839
13840 Example :
13841 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
13842 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
13843 # the request.
13844 frontend http-in
13845 bind *:8081
13846 default_backend servers
13847 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13848 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13849
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013850ssl_bc : boolean
13851 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13852 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13853 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13854
13855ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13856 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13857 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13858
13859ssl_bc_cipher : string
13860 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13861 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13862
13863ssl_bc_protocol : string
13864 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13865 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13866
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013867ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013868 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013869 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13870 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013871
13872ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13873 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13874 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13875 if session was reused or not.
13876
13877ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13878 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13879 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013881ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13882 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13883 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13884 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13885 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13886 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013888ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13889 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13890 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13891 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13892 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013893
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013894ssl_c_der : binary
13895 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13896 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13897 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013899ssl_c_err : integer
13900 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13901 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13902 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13903 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13904 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013906ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13907 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13908 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13909 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13910 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13911 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13912 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13913 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13914 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013916ssl_c_key_alg : string
13917 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13918 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13919 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013921ssl_c_notafter : string
13922 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13923 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13924 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013926ssl_c_notbefore : string
13927 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13928 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13929 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013931ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13932 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13933 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13934 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13935 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13936 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13937 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13938 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13939 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013941ssl_c_serial : binary
13942 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13943 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13944 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013946ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13947 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13948 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13949 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013950 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13951 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13952
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013953 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013954 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013956ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13957 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13958 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13959 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013961ssl_c_used : boolean
13962 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13963 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013965ssl_c_verify : integer
13966 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13967 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13968 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13969 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013971ssl_c_version : integer
13972 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13973 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013974
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013975ssl_f_der : binary
13976 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13977 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13978 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013980ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13981 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13982 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13983 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13984 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013985 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013986 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13987 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13988 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013990ssl_f_key_alg : string
13991 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13992 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13993 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013995ssl_f_notafter : string
13996 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13997 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13998 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014000ssl_f_notbefore : string
14001 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14002 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14003 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014005ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14006 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14007 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14008 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14009 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14010 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14011 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14012 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14013 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014015ssl_f_serial : binary
14016 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14017 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14018 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014019
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014020ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14021 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14022 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14023 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014025ssl_f_sig_alg : string
14026 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14027 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14028 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014030ssl_f_version : integer
14031 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14032 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14033
14034ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014035 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14036 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
14037 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
14038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014039 Example :
14040 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
14041 listen http-https
14042 bind :80
14043 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
14044 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
14045
14046ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
14047 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
14048 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14049
14050ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014051 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014052 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14053 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14054 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14055 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14056 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14057 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14058 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14059 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014061ssl_fc_cipher : string
14062 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14063 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014064
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014065ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14066 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14067 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014068 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014069
14070ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14071 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14072 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014073 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014074
14075ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14076 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14077 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14078 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
14079 avaible with OpenSSL > 1.0.2 compiled with the option enable-ssl-trace.
14080 If the function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash
14081 like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
14082
14083ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14084 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14085 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014086 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014088ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014089 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14090 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014091 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14092 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14093 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14094 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014096ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14097 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014098 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14099 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14100 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14101 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014102
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014103ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014104 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
14105 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
14106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014107ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014108 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014109 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14110 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14111 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14112 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14113 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14114 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14115 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014117ssl_fc_protocol : string
14118 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14119 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014120
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014121ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014122 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014123 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14124 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014126ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14127 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14128 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14129 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14130 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014132ssl_fc_sni : string
14133 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14134 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14135 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14136 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14137 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14138
14139 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14140 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14141 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014142 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14143 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014145 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014146 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14147 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014149ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14150 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14151 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014152
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014153
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200141547.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014155------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014157Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14158sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14159only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14160For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14161be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14162can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14163sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14164for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14165content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014167payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
14168 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
14169 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14170 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014172payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14173 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
14174 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14175 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014176
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020014177req.hdrs : string
14178 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
14179 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
14180 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
14181 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
14182
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020014183req.hdrs_bin : binary
14184 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
14185 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
14186 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
14187 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
14188 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
14189 names and values (length of 0 for both).
14190
14191 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
14192
14193 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
14194 str: <int:length><bytes>
14195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014196req.len : integer
14197req_len : integer (deprecated)
14198 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14199 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14200 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14201 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14202 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14203 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14204 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14205 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014207req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14208 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014209 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14210 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14211 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14212 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014214 ACL alternatives :
14215 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014217req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14218 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14219 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14220 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14221 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014223 ACL alternatives :
14224 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014226 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014228req.proto_http : boolean
14229req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14230 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14231 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14232 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14233 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14234 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14235 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14236 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014238 Example:
14239 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14240 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14241 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014242 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014244req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14245rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14246 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14247 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14248 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14249 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14250 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14251 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14252 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014254 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14255 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14256 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14257 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14258 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14259 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014261 ACL derivatives :
14262 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014264 Example :
14265 listen tse-farm
14266 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14267 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14268 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14269 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14270 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14271 persist rdp-cookie
14272 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14273 # This is only useful makes sense if
14274 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14275 stick-table type string size 204800
14276 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14277 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14278 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014280 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14281 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014283req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14284rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14285 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14286 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14287 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14288 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014289
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014290 ACL derivatives :
14291 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014292
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014293req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14294 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14295 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014296 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14297 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14298 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14299 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14300 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014302req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14303req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14304 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14305 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14306 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14307 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14308 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14309 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14310 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014312req.ssl_sni : string
14313req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14314 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14315 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14316 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14317 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14318 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14319 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14320 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14321 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14322 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14323 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14324 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14325 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014327 ACL derivatives :
14328 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014330 Examples :
14331 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14332 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14333 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14334 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14335 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014336
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014337req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14338 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14339 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14340 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14341 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14342 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14343 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14344 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14345 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14346 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14347
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014348req.ssl_ver : integer
14349req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14350 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14351 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14352 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14353 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14354 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14355 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14356 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14357 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14358 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014360 ACL derivatives :
14361 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014362
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014363res.len : integer
14364 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14365 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14366 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14367 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14368 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14369 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14370 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14371 content inspection.
14372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014373res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14374 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014375 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14376 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14377 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14378 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014380res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14381 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14382 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14383 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14384 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014386 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014387
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014388res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14389rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14390 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14391 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14392 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14393 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14394 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14395 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14396 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014398wait_end : boolean
14399 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14400 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14401 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14402 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14403 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14404 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14405 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14406 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014408 Examples :
14409 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14410 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14411 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014413 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14414 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14415 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14416 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14417 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14418 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14419 tcp-request content reject
14420
14421
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144227.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014423--------------------------------------
14424
14425It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14426This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14427data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14428its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14429HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14430content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14431to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14432more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14433response are indexed.
14434
14435base : string
14436 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14437 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14438 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14439 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14440 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14441 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14442 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14443 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14444
14445 ACL derivatives :
14446 base : exact string match
14447 base_beg : prefix match
14448 base_dir : subdir match
14449 base_dom : domain match
14450 base_end : suffix match
14451 base_len : length match
14452 base_reg : regex match
14453 base_sub : substring match
14454
14455base32 : integer
14456 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14457 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14458 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014459 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14460 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14461 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014462
14463base32+src : binary
14464 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14465 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14466 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14467 per-URL counters.
14468
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014469capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14470 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14471 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14472 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14473
14474capture.req.method : string
14475 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14476 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14477 because it's allocated.
14478
14479capture.req.uri : string
14480 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14481 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14482 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14483 allocated.
14484
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014485capture.req.ver : string
14486 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14487 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14488 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14489
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014490capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14491 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14492 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14493 The first entry is an index of 0.
14494 See also: "capture response header"
14495
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014496capture.res.ver : string
14497 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14498 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14499 persistent flag.
14500
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014501req.body : binary
14502 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14503 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14504 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14505 the first chunk is analyzed.
14506
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014507req.body_param([<name>) : string
14508 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14509 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14510 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14511 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14512 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14513 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14514 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14515 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14516 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14517 given.
14518
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014519req.body_len : integer
14520 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14521 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14522 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14523 "option http-buffer-request".
14524
14525req.body_size : integer
14526 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14527 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14528 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14529 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14530 "option http-buffer-request".
14531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014532req.cook([<name>]) : string
14533cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14534 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14535 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14536 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14537 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14538 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14539 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14540 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14541 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14542
14543 ACL derivatives :
14544 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14545 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14546 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14547 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14548 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14549 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14550 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14551 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014553req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14554cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14555 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14556 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014558req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14559cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14560 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14561 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14562 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14563 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014565cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14566 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14567 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14568 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14569 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014570 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014571 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14572 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14573 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14574 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014576hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14577 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14578 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14579 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14580 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014581 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014583req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14584 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14585 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14586 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14587 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14588 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14589 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14590 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14591 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014593req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14594 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14595 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14596 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14597 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014599req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14600 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14601 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14602 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14603 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14604 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14605 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14606 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14607 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000014608 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014609 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14610 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014612 ACL derivatives :
14613 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14614 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14615 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14616 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14617 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14618 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14619 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14620 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14621
14622req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14623hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14624 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14625 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14626 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14627 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14628 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14629 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14630 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14631 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14632 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14633
14634req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14635hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14636 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14637 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14638 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14639 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14640 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14641 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14642 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14643 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14644
14645req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14646hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14647 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14648 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14649 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14650 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14651 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14652 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14653 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14654
14655http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14656 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14657 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14658 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14659 basic auth is supported.
14660
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014661http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14662 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14663 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14664 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14665 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014666 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14667 basic auth is supported.
14668
14669 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014670 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14671 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14672 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14673 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014674
14675http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014676 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14677 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014678 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14679 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014681method : integer + string
14682 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14683 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14684 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14685 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14686 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14687 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14688 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014690 ACL derivatives :
14691 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014693 Example :
14694 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14695 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14696 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014698path : string
14699 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14700 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14701 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14702 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14703 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14704 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14705 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014707 ACL derivatives :
14708 path : exact string match
14709 path_beg : prefix match
14710 path_dir : subdir match
14711 path_dom : domain match
14712 path_end : suffix match
14713 path_len : length match
14714 path_reg : regex match
14715 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014716
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014717query : string
14718 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14719 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14720 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14721 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014722 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014723 which stops before the question mark.
14724
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014725req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14726 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14727 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14728 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14729 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014731req.ver : string
14732req_ver : string (deprecated)
14733 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14734 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14735 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014737 ACL derivatives :
14738 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014740res.comp : boolean
14741 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14742 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14743 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014745res.comp_algo : string
14746 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14747 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14748 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014750res.cook([<name>]) : string
14751scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14752 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14753 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14754 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014756 ACL derivatives :
14757 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014759res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14760scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14761 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14762 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14763 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014765res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14766scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14767 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14768 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14769 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014771res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14772 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14773 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14774 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14775 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14776 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14777 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14778 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14779 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14780 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014782res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14783 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14784 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14785 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14786 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14787 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014789res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14790shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14791 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14792 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14793 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14794 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14795 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14796 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14797 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14798 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014800 ACL derivatives :
14801 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14802 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14803 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14804 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14805 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14806 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14807 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14808 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14809
14810res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14811shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14812 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14813 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14814 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14815 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14816 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014818res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14819shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14820 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14821 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14822 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14823 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14824 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14825 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014826
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014827res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14828 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14829 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14830 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14831 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014833res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14834shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14835 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14836 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14837 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14838 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14839 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14840 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014842res.ver : string
14843resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14844 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14845 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014847 ACL derivatives :
14848 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014850set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14851 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14852 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014853 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014854 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014856 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14857 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014859status : integer
14860 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14861 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14862 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014863
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014864unique-id : string
14865 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14866 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14867 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14868 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14869 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14870 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014872url : string
14873 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14874 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14875 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14876 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14877 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14878 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14879 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014881 ACL derivatives :
14882 url : exact string match
14883 url_beg : prefix match
14884 url_dir : subdir match
14885 url_dom : domain match
14886 url_end : suffix match
14887 url_len : length match
14888 url_reg : regex match
14889 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014891url_ip : ip
14892 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14893 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14894 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14895 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14896 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14897 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14898 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014900url_port : integer
14901 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14902 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14903 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14904 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014905
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014906urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14907url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014908 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14909 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014910 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14911 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14912 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14913 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014914 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14915 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014916 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14917 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014919 ACL derivatives :
14920 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14921 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14922 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14923 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14924 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14925 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14926 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14927 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014928
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014930 Example :
14931 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14932 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14933 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14934 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014935
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014936urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014937 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14938 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14939 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014940
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014941url32 : integer
14942 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14943 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14944 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14945 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14946 is an unsigned integer.
14947
14948url32+src : binary
14949 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14950 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14951 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14952
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149547.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014955---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014956
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014957Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14958every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014959order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014960
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014961ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14962---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014963FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014964HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014965HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14966HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014967HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14968HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14969HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14970HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14971LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014972METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014973METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014974METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14975METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14976METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14977METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014978METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014979METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014980RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014981REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014982TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014983WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14984---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014985
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014986
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149878. Logging
14988----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014989
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014990One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14991provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14992very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14993provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14994state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014995to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014996headers.
14997
14998In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14999about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
15000send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
15001
15002 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
15003 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
15004 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
15005 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
15006 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060015007 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
15008 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015009
15010The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
15011allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
15012as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
15013while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
15014real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
15015delay.
15016
15017
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150188.1. Log levels
15019---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015020
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015021TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015022source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015023HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
15024in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
15025track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
15026syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
15027about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015028
15029
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150308.2. Log formats
15031----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015032
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015033HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015034and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
15035slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
15036options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015037
15038 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
15039 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
15040 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
15041 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
15042 extents.
15043
15044 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
15045 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
15046 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
15047 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
15048 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
15049
15050 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
15051 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
15052 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
15053 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
15054 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
15055
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020015056 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
15057 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
15058 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
15059 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
15060
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015061 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
15062
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015063Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
15064specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
15065field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
15066servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
15067always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
15068identifier.
15069
15070Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15071 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15072 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15073 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15074 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15075
15076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150778.2.1. Default log format
15078-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015079
15080This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15081as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15082format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15083
15084 Example :
15085 listen www
15086 mode http
15087 log global
15088 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15089
15090 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15091 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15092 (www/HTTP)
15093
15094 Field Format Extract from the example above
15095 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15096 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15097 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15098 4 'to' to
15099 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15100 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15101
15102Detailed fields description :
15103 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15104 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15105 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15106 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15107 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15108 and processed the connection.
15109 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15110
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015111In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15112"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15113connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15114
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015115It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15116will eventually disappear.
15117
15118
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151198.2.2. TCP log format
15120---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015121
15122The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15123is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15124information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15125counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15126emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15127environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15128the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15129sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015130specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15131not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15132fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15133marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015134
15135 Example :
15136 frontend fnt
15137 mode tcp
15138 option tcplog
15139 log global
15140 default_backend bck
15141
15142 backend bck
15143 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15144
15145 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15146 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15147 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15148
15149 Field Format Extract from the example above
15150 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15151 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15152 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15153 4 frontend_name fnt
15154 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15155 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15156 7 bytes_read* 212
15157 8 termination_state --
15158 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15159 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15160
15161Detailed fields description :
15162 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015163 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15164 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15165 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015166 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15167 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15168 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015169
15170 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015171 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15172 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15173 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015174
15175 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15176 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15177 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15178 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15179
15180 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15181 and processed the connection.
15182
15183 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15184 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15185 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15186 applications.
15187
15188 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15189 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15190 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15191 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15192 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15193
15194 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15195 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15196 See "Timers" below for more details.
15197
15198 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15199 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15200 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15201 "Timers" below for more details.
15202
15203 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015204 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015205 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15206 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15207 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15208 details.
15209
15210 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15211 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15212 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15213 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15214 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15215
15216 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15217 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15218 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15219 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15220 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15221 for more details.
15222
15223 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015224 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015225 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15226 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15227 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015228 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015229
15230 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15231 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15232 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15233 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15234 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15235 caused by a denial of service attack.
15236
15237 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15238 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15239 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15240 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15241 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15242 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15243 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15244 denial of service attack.
15245
15246 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15247 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15248 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15249 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15250 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15251 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15252 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15253 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15254 be processed than on other servers.
15255
15256 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15257 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15258 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15259 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15260 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15261 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15262 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15263 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15264 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15265 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15266 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15267 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15268 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15269
15270 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15271 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15272 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15273 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15274 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15275 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15276 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15277 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15278
15279 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15280 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15281 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15282 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15283 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15284 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15285 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15286 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15287 occurs.
15288
15289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152908.2.3. HTTP log format
15291----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015292
15293The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15294is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15295the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15296are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15297emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15298generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15299"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15300which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015301frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15302is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015303
15304Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15305slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15306with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15307
15308 Example :
15309 frontend http-in
15310 mode http
15311 option httplog
15312 log global
15313 default_backend bck
15314
15315 backend static
15316 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15317
15318 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15319 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15320 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015321 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015322
15323 Field Format Extract from the example above
15324 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15325 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015326 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015327 4 frontend_name http-in
15328 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015329 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015330 7 status_code 200
15331 8 bytes_read* 2750
15332 9 captured_request_cookie -
15333 10 captured_response_cookie -
15334 11 termination_state ----
15335 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15336 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15337 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15338 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15339 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015340
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015341Detailed fields description :
15342 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015343 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15344 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15345 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015346 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15347 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15348 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015349
15350 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015351 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15352 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15353 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015354
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015355 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15356 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015357
15358 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15359 and processed the connection.
15360
15361 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15362 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15363 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15364
15365 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15366 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15367 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15368 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15369 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15370 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15371
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015372 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15373 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15374 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15375 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15376 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15377 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15378 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015379
15380 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15381 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15382 See "Timers" below for more details.
15383
15384 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15385 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15386 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15387 below for more details.
15388
15389 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15390 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15391 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15392 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15393 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15394 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15395 for more details.
15396
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015397 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15398 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15399 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15400 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15401 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15402 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15403 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15404 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015405
15406 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15407 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15408 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15409
15410 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15411 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15412 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15413 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15414 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15415 overflowing.
15416
15417 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15418 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15419 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15420 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15421 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15422 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15423 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15424 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15425
15426 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15427 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15428 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15429 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15430 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15431 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15432 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15433 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15434
15435 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15436 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15437 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15438 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15439 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15440 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15441 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15442
15443 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015444 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015445 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15446 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15447 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015448 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015449 system.
15450
15451 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15452 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15453 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15454 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15455 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15456 caused by a denial of service attack.
15457
15458 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15459 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15460 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15461 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15462 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15463 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15464 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15465 denial of service attack.
15466
15467 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15468 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15469 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15470 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15471 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15472 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15473 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15474 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15475 processed than on other servers.
15476
15477 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15478 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15479 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15480 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15481 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15482 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15483 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15484 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15485 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15486 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15487 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15488 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15489 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15490
15491 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15492 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15493 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15494 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15495 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15496 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15497 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15498 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15499
15500 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15501 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15502 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15503 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15504 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15505 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15506 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15507 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15508 occurs.
15509
15510 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15511 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15512 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15513 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15514 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15515 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15516 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15517 cookies" below for more details.
15518
15519 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15520 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15521 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15522 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15523 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15524 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15525 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15526 and cookies" below for more details.
15527
15528 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15529 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15530 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15531 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15532 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15533 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15534 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15535 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15536
15537
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200155388.2.4. Custom log format
15539------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015540
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015541The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015542mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015543
15544HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15545Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15546separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15547prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15548
15549Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15550variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015551("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015552
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015553If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015554as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015555less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15556the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15557
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015558Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015559In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015560in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015561
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015562Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15563'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15564https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15565such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15566
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015567Flags are :
15568 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015569 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015570 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15571 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015572
15573 Example:
15574
15575 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15576 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15577
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015578 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15579
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015580At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15581
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015582 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15583 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015584
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015585the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015586
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015587 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15588 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15589 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015590
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015591and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15592
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015593 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15594 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015595
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015596Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15597
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015598 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015599 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015600 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15601 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15602 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015603 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15604 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15605 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015606 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015607 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15608 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015609 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015610 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15611 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015612 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015613 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015614 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015615 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015616 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015617 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015618 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015619 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15620 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15621 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15622 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15623 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015624 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015625 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15626 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015627 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015628 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15629 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015630 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15631 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15632 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015633 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015634 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15635 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015636 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015637 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15638 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15639 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015640 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015641 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015642 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15643 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15644 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15645 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015646 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015647 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015648 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015649 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015650 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015651 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015652 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15653 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15654 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015655 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015656 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15657 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015658 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015659 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15660 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15661 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015662 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015663 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015664 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015665
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015666 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015667
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015668
156698.2.5. Error log format
15670-----------------------
15671
15672When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15673protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15674By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15675"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15676will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15677logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15678
15679The format looks like this :
15680
15681 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15682 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15683 Connection error during SSL handshake
15684
15685 Field Format Extract from the example above
15686 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15687 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15688 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15689 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15690 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15691
15692These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15693failures.
15694
15695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156968.3. Advanced logging options
15697-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015698
15699Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15700just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15701options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15702for more information about their usage.
15703
15704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15706------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015707
15708It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15709haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15710commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15711monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15712ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15713
15714 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15715 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15716 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15717 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15718
15719 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15720 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15721 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015722 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015723 such as other load-balancers.
15724
15725 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15726 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15727 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15728
15729
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157308.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15731----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015732
15733The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15734what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15735or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15736"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15737just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15738log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15739after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15740is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15741with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15742with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15743
15744
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157458.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15746------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015747
15748Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15749for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15750"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15751retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15752raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15753a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15754file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15755you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15756"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15757
15758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157598.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15760--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015761
15762Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15763multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15764them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15765"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15766logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15767error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15768and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15769too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15770useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15771alternative.
15772
15773
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157748.4. Timing events
15775------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015776
15777Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15778reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15779the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15780frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015781mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
15782addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
15783
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010015784Timings events in HTTP mode:
15785
15786 first request 2nd request
15787 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
15788 t tr t tr ...
15789 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
15790 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
15791 :<---- Tq ---->: :
15792 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
15793 :<--------- Ta --------->:
15794
15795Timings events in TCP mode:
15796
15797 TCP session
15798 |<----------------->|
15799 t t
15800 ---|----|----|----|----|---
15801 | Th Tw Tc Td |
15802 |<------ Tt ------->|
15803
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015804 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
15805 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
15806 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
15807 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
15808 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
15809 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
15810 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015811
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015812 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
15813 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
15814 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
15815 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
15816 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
15817 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
15818 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
15819 nothing was received on the connection.
15820
15821 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15822 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
15823 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
15824 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
15825 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
15826 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
15827 request typed by hand during a test.
15828
15829 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
15830 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
15831 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
15832 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
15833 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
15834 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
15835 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015836
15837 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15838 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15839 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15840 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15841 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15842
15843 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15844 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15845 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15846 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15847 connection never established.
15848
15849 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15850 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15851 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15852 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15853 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15854 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15855 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15856 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15857 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15858 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15859 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15860
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015861 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
15862 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
15863 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
15864 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
15865 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
15866 by subtracting other timers when valid :
15867
15868 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15869
15870 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
15871 "Ta" can never be negative.
15872
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015873 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15874 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015875 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
15876 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015877 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015878
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015879 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015880
15881 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015882 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
15883 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015884
15885These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15886protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15887that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015888due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
15889"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
15890that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015891
15892Most common cases :
15893
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015894 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
15895 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
15896 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
15897 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
15898 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
15899 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
15900 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
15901 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
15902 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
15903 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
15904 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015905 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015906
15907 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15908 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15909 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15910 of ms on remote networks.
15911
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015912 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15913 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15914 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015915
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015916 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15917 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
15918 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
15919 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
15920 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
15921 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
15922 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
15923 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
15924 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015925
15926Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15927
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015928 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015929 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015930 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015931
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015932 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015933 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15934 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15935
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015936 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015937 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15938 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15939 flags.
15940
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015941 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15942 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015943 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15944 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15945 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15946 the client connection was maintained open.
15947
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015948 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015949 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015950 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015951 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15952
15953
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159548.5. Session state at disconnection
15955-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015956
15957TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15958"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
159592-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15960each of which has a special meaning :
15961
15962 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15963 session to terminate :
15964
15965 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15966
15967 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15968 server explicitly refused it.
15969
15970 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15971 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15972 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15973 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015974 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15975
15976 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15977 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015978
15979 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15980 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15981 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15982 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15983 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15984
15985 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15986 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15987 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15988 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15989 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15990
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015991 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15992 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15993
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015994 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15995 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15996 backup connections when going up.
15997
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015998 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15999
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016000 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
16001 send or receive data.
16002
16003 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
16004 send or receive data.
16005
16006 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
16007 with nothing left in the buffers.
16008
16009 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
16010
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010016011 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016012 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
16013
16014 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
16015 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
16016 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
16017 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
16018 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
16019
16020 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
16021 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
16022
16023 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
16024 server (HTTP only).
16025
16026 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
16027
16028 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
16029 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
16030 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
16031
16032 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
16033 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
16034 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
16035
16036 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
16037
16038 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
16039 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
16040
16041 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
16042 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
16043 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
16044
16045 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
16046 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020016047 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
16048 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016049
16050 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
16051 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
16052 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
16053 another server.
16054
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016055 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016056 server.
16057
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016058 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
16059 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
16060 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
16061 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16062
16063 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
16064 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
16065 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
16066 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16067
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020016068 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
16069 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16070 "use-server" rule).
16071
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016072 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16073
16074 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16075 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16076
16077 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16078
16079 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16080 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16081 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16082
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016083 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16084 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016085 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016086 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16087 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16088
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016089 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16090
16091 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16092 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16093
16094 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16095
16096 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16097
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016098The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16099was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016100helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16101starvation, attacks, etc...
16102
16103The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16104alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16105easier finding and understanding.
16106
16107 Flags Reason
16108
16109 -- Normal termination.
16110
16111 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16112 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16113 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16114 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16115
16116 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16117 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16118 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16119 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16120 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16121 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016122
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016123 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16124 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016125 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016126
16127 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16128 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16129 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16130
16131 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16132 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16133 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16134 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16135 the server takes too long to respond.
16136
16137 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16138 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16139 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16140 long a time to respond.
16141
16142 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16143 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16144 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16145 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016146 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16147 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016148
16149 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16150 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16151 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16152 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16153 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016154 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016155 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16156 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16157 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16158 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16159 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16160 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16161 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16162 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
16163 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
16164 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16165 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16166 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016167
16168 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16169 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016170 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16171 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16172 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16173 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016174
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016175 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16176 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16177
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016178 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016179 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16180 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
16181 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
16182 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16183 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16184
16185 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16186 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16187 503 or 504 here.
16188
16189 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16190 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16191 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16192 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16193 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16194
16195 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16196 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016197 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016198 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16199 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16200
16201 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16202 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16203 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16204 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16205 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16206 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16207 between haproxy and the server.
16208
16209 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16210 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16211 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16212 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16213 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16214 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16215 solution is to fix the application.
16216
16217 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16218 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16219 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16220 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16221 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16222 external attacks.
16223
16224 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16225 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016226 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016227 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16228 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16229
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016230 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16231 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16232 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016233 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16234 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016235
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016236 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16237 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16238 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16239 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016240 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16241 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16242 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16243 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16244 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016245
16246 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16247 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16248 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16249 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16250
16251 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16252 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16253 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16254 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16255
16256 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16257 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16258 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16259 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16260
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016261The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16262persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16263important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16264re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16265
16266 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16267
16268 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16269 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16270 set on a GET request.
16271
16272 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16273 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016274 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016275 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16276
16277 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16278 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16279 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16280
16281 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16282 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16283 already got a cookie.
16284
16285 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16286 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16287 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16288 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16289 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16290
16291 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16292 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16293 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16294
16295 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16296 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16297 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16298
16299 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16300 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16301
16302 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16303 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16304 then advertised in the response.
16305
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016306
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163078.6. Non-printable characters
16308-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016309
16310In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16311consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16312converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16313prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16314being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16315escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16316is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16317'}' when logging headers.
16318
16319Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16320issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16321containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16322
16323Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16324the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16325performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16326
16327
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163288.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16329---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016330
16331Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16332achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016333section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016334cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16335the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16336the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016337locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016338not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16339user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16340a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16341wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16342
16343 Examples :
16344 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16345 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16346
16347 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16348 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16349
16350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163518.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16352---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016353
16354Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16355proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16356the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16357server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16358
16359Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16360response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016361section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016362
16363It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016364time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16365appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016366are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16367and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16368follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16369request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16370in the logs.
16371
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016372As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16373frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16374an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16375
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016376 Example :
16377 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16378 listen proxy-out
16379 mode http
16380 option httplog
16381 option logasap
16382 log global
16383 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16384
16385 # log the name of the virtual server
16386 capture request header Host len 20
16387
16388 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16389 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16390
16391 # log the beginning of the referrer
16392 capture request header Referer len 20
16393
16394 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16395 capture response header Server len 20
16396
16397 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16398 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16399
16400 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16401 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16402
16403 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16404 capture response header Via len 20
16405
16406 # log the URL location during a redirection
16407 capture response header Location len 20
16408
16409 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16410 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16411 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16412 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16413 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16414
16415 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16416 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16417 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16418 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016419 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016420
16421 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16422 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16423 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16424 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16425 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016426 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016427
16428
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164298.9. Examples of logs
16430---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016431
16432These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16433them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16434reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16435
16436 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16437 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16438 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16439
16440 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16441 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16442
16443 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16444 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16445 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16446
16447 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16448 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16449
16450 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16451 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16452 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16453
16454 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016455 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016456 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16457 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16458
16459 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16460 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16461 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16462
16463 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16464 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016465 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016466 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16467 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16468 to return the 502 and not the server.
16469
16470 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016471 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016472
16473 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16474 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16475 Nothing was sent to any server.
16476
16477 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16478 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16479
16480 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16481 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16482 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16483 send a 408 return code to the client.
16484
16485 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16486 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16487
16488 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16489 5 seconds ("c----").
16490
16491 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16492 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016493 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016494
16495 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016496 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016497 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16498 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16499 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16500 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16501 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016502
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016503
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200165049. Supported filters
16505--------------------
16506
16507Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16508accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16509unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16510
16511See also : "filter"
16512
165139.1. Trace
16514----------
16515
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016516filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016517
16518 Arguments:
16519 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16520 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16521
16522 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16523 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16524 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16525 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16526
16527 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16528 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16529 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16530 amount of the parsed data.
16531
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016532 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16533
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016534This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16535callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16536information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16537filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16538
16539Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16540tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16541a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16542
16543
165449.2. HTTP compression
16545---------------------
16546
16547filter compression
16548
16549The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16550keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16551when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16552use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16553used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16554filters evaluation order.
16555
16556See also : "compression"
16557
16558
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200165599.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16560--------------------------------------------
16561
16562filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16563
16564 Arguments :
16565
16566 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16567 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16568 parsed.
16569
16570 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16571 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16572 part must be placed in its own scope.
16573
16574The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16575external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16576streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16577exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16578also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16579
16580SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16581the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16582
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016583For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016584"doc/SPOE.txt".
16585
16586Important note:
16587 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16588 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16589
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016590/*
16591 * Local variables:
16592 * fill-column: 79
16593 * End:
16594 */